blob: c4060ce7a6b970c6149a9f4c7d81878e20fe3d9d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau50bdda62015-07-22 17:32:56 +02007 2015/07/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200545 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200546 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200549 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200551 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100552 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100553 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200555 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200556 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200557 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - noepoll
559 - nokqueue
560 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100561 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300562 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200563 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200564 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200565 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100566 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100567 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200568 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100569 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100570 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100571 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100572 - tune.lua.session-timeout
573 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100574 - tune.maxaccept
575 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200576 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200577 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200578 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100579 - tune.rcvbuf.client
580 - tune.rcvbuf.server
581 - tune.sndbuf.client
582 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100583 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100584 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200585 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100586 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200587 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200588 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200589 - tune.vars.global-max-size
590 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
591 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
592 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100593 - tune.zlib.memlevel
594 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 * Debugging
597 - debug
598 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602------------------------------------
603
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200604ca-base <dir>
605 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200606 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
607 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609chroot <jail dir>
610 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
611 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
612 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
613 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
614 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
615 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100616
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100617cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
618 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
619 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
620 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100621 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
622 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
623 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
624 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
625 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
626 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
627 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
628 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
629 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
630 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100631
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632crt-base <dir>
633 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
634 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
635 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637daemon
638 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
639 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
640 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
641
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200642deviceatlas-json-file <path>
643 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
644 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
645
646deviceatlas-log-level <value>
647 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
648 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
649
650deviceatlas-separator <char>
651 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
652 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900654external-check
655 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
656 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
657 See "option external-check".
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659gid <number>
660 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
661 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
662 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100663 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
664 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200665 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667group <group name>
668 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
669 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200671log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
673 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 configured with "log global".
675
676 <address> can be one of:
677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100678 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100679 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
680 port).
681
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100682 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
683 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
684 port).
685
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100686 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
687 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
688 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
689 writeable).
690
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200691 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
692 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100693
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200694 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
695 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
696 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
697 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
698 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
699 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
700 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
701 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
702 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
703 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
704 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
705
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100706 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
709 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
710 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
711
712 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200713 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
714 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
715 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
716 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
717 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
718 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200720 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100722log-send-hostname [<string>]
723 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
724 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
725 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
726 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
727 the logs.
728
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000729log-tag <string>
730 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
731 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
732 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100733 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000734
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100735lua-load <file>
736 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
737 used multiple times.
738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200739nbproc <number>
740 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
741 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
742 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
743 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
744 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
745
746pidfile <pidfile>
747 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
748 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
749 starting the process. See also "daemon".
750
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100751stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200752 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
753 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
754 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
755 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
756 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
757 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100758 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200759 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
760 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200761
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100762ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
764 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300765 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100766 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
767 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
768 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
769 "bind" keyword for more information.
770
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100771ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
773 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
774 keyword to see available options.
775
776 Example:
777 global
778 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
779
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100780ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
782 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300783 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100784 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
785 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
786 information.
787
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100788ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
790 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
791 keyword to see available options.
792
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200793ssl-dh-param-file <file>
794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
795 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
796 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
797 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
798 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
799 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
800 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
801 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
802 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
803 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
804 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
805 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
806
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100807ssl-server-verify [none|required]
808 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
809 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
810 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200812stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
813 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
814 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
815 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
816 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200817
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200818 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
819 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
820 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200821
822stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
823 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
824 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100825 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200826
827stats maxconn <connections>
828 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
829 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831uid <number>
832 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
833 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
834 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
835 one. See also "gid" and "user".
836
837ulimit-n <number>
838 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
839 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
840 option.
841
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100842unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
843 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
844
845 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
846 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
847 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
848 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
849 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
850 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
851 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
852 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
853 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
854 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856user <user name>
857 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
858 See also "uid" and "group".
859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200860node <name>
861 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
862
863 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
864 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
865 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
866 traffic.
867
868description <text>
869 Add a text that describes the instance.
870
871 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
872 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
873 "<" and ">" characters.
874
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087551degrees-data-file <file path>
876 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
877 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
878
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200879 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100880 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
881
88251degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
883 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
884 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
885 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
886
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100888 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
889
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020089051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100891 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
892 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
896
89751degrees-cache-size <number>
898 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
899 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
900 By default, this cache is disabled.
901
902 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100903 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907-----------------------
908
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200909max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
910 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
911 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
912 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
913 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
914 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
915 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
916 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
917 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919maxconn <number>
920 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
921 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
922 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200923 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
924 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
925 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
926 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100927 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
928 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
929 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
930 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
931 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200933maxconnrate <number>
934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
941 fairness.
942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100943maxcomprate <number>
944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
950 default value.
951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100952maxcompcpuusage <number>
953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962maxpipes <number>
963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200970maxsessrate <number>
971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
978 fairness.
979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200980maxsslconn <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200996maxsslrate <number>
997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001008maxzlibmem <number>
1009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016noepoll
1017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
1021nokqueue
1022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1025
1026nopoll
1027 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1028 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001030 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001032nosplice
1033 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1034 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1035 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001036 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001037 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1038 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1039 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1040 "option splice-response".
1041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001042nogetaddrinfo
1043 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1044 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1045
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001046spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001047 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1048 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1049 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1050 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1051 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1052 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001053
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001054tune.buffers.limit <number>
1055 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1056 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1057 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1058 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1059 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1060 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1061 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1062 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1063 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1064 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1065 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1066 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1067 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1068 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1069 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1070
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001071tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1072 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1073 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1074 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1075 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1076
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001077tune.bufsize <number>
1078 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1079 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1080 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1081 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1082 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1083 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1084 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1085 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001086 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1087 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1088 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001090tune.chksize <number>
1091 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1092 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1093 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1094 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1095 checks whenever possible.
1096
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001097tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1098 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1099 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1100 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1101 this value. The default value is 1.
1102
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001103tune.http.cookielen <number>
1104 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1105 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1106 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1107 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1108 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1109 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1110 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1111 to change this value.
1112
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001113tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1114 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1115 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1116 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1117 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1118 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1119 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1120 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1121 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1122 limit too high.
1123
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124tune.idletimer <timeout>
1125 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1126 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1127 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1128 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1129 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1130 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1131 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1132 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1133 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1134
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1136 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1137 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1138 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1139 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1140 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1141 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1142 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1143
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001144tune.lua.maxmem
1145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1146 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1147 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1148 memory.
1149
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001150tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1151 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1152 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1153 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1154 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1155 4s.
1156
1157tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1158 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1159 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1160 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1161 check servers.
1162
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001163tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001164 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1165 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1166 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1167 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1168 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1169 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1170 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1171 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1172 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1173 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001174
1175tune.maxpollevents <number>
1176 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1177 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1178 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1179 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1180 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1181
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001182tune.maxrewrite <number>
1183 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1184 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1185 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1186 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1187 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1188 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1189 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1190 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1191 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1192 bufsize.
1193
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001194tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1195 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1196 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1197 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1198 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1199 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1200 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1201 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1202 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1203 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1204 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1205 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1206 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1207 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1208 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1209 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1210 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1211 setting this parameter to 0.
1212
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001213tune.pipesize <number>
1214 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1215 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1216 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1217 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1218 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1219 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1220
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001221tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1222tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1223 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1224 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1225 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1226 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1227 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1228 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1229 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1230
1231tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1232tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1233 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1234 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1235 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1236 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1237 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1238 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1239 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1240 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1241 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1242 notifying haproxy again.
1243
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001244tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001245 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1246 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1247 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001248 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001249 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1250 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1251 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1252 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1253 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001254 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1255 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001256
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001257tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1258 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1259 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1260 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1261 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1262 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1263 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1264
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001265tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1266 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001268 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1269 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1270 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1271 being used for too long.
1272
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001273tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1274 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1275 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1276 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1277 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1278 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1279 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1280 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1281 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1282 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1283 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001284 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1285 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001286
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001287tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1288 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1289 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1290 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1291 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1292 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1293 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1294 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1296 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001297
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001298tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1299 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1300 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1301 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1302 1000 entries.
1303
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001304tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1305tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1306tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1307tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1308 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1309 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1310 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1311 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1312 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1313
1314 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1315 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1316 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1317 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1325
1326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323.3. Debugging
1333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335debug
1336 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1337 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1338 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1339 system startup.
1340
1341quiet
1342 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1343 line argument "-q".
1344
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013463.4. Userlists
1347--------------
1348It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1349http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1350it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1351
1352userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001353 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1355
1356group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001357 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1359 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1360
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001361user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1362 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001363 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1364 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001365 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1366 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001367 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001368 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001369
1370
1371 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001372 userlist L1
1373 group G1 users tiger,scott
1374 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001375
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001376 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1377 user scott insecure-password elgato
1378 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001380 userlist L2
1381 group G1
1382 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1385 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1386 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001387
1388 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001390
13913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001392----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001393It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1394several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1395instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1396values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1397automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1398In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1399using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1400tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1401reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1402Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1403that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1404each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001405
1406peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001407 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001408 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1409
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001410disabled
1411 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1412 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1413 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1414
1415enable
1416 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1417
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001418peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1419 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1420 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1421 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1422 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1423 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1424 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1425
1426 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1427 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1428
1429 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1430 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1431 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1432 across all peers.
1433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1435 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001436
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001437 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001438 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001439 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1440 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1441 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
1443 backend mybackend
1444 mode tcp
1445 balance roundrobin
1446 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1447 stick on src
1448
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001449 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1450 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001451
1452
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014533.6. Mailers
1454------------
1455It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1456If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1457in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1458
1459mailer <mailersect>
1460 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1461 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1462
1463mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1464 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1465
1466 Example:
1467 mailers mymailers
1468 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1469 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1470
1471 backend mybackend
1472 mode tcp
1473 balance roundrobin
1474
1475 email-alert mailers mymailers
1476 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1477 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1478
1479 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1480 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1481
1482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001487 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001488 - frontend <name>
1489 - backend <name>
1490 - listen <name>
1491
1492A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1493its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1494section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001496
1497A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1498connections.
1499
1500A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1501to forward incoming connections.
1502
1503A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1504parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1507'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1508case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1509
1510Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1511logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1512proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1513However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1514name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1515
1516Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1517and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001518bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1520modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1521arbitrary criteria.
1522
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001523In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1524a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1525the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1526
1527 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1528 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1529 between responses and new requests.
1530
1531 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1532 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1533 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1534 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1535
1536 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1537 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1538 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1539
1540 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1541 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1542 client-facing connection remains open.
1543
1544 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1545 after the end of the response.
1546
1547The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1548frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1549following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1550weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1551
1552 Backend mode
1553
1554 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1555 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1556 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1557 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1558 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1559 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1560 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1561 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1562 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1563 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1564 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1569--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001571The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1572limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1573they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1574limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001575marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001576option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001577and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1578with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1579specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001582 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1584acl - X X X
1585appsession - - X X
1586backlog X X X -
1587balance X - X X
1588bind - X X -
1589bind-process X X X X
1590block - X X X
1591capture cookie - X X -
1592capture request header - X X -
1593capture response header - X X -
1594clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001595compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1597cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001598declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599default-server X - X X
1600default_backend X X X -
1601description - X X X
1602disabled X X X X
1603dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001604email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001605email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001606email-alert mailers X X X X
1607email-alert myhostname X X X X
1608email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001609enabled X X X X
1610errorfile X X X X
1611errorloc X X X X
1612errorloc302 X X X X
1613-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1614errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001615force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616fullconn X - X X
1617grace X X X X
1618hash-type X - X X
1619http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001620http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001621http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001622http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001623http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001624http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001625id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001626ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001627log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001628log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001629log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001630max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001631maxconn X X X -
1632mode X X X X
1633monitor fail - X X -
1634monitor-net X X X -
1635monitor-uri X X X -
1636option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1637option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1638option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1639option allbackups (*) X - X X
1640option checkcache (*) X - X X
1641option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1642option contstats (*) X X X -
1643option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1644option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1645option forceclose (*) X X X X
1646-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1647option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001648option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001649option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001650option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001651option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001652option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001653option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001654option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001655option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1656option httpchk X - X X
1657option httpclose (*) X X X X
1658option httplog X X X X
1659option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001660option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001661option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001662option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001663option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1664option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1665option logasap (*) X X X -
1666option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001667option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001668option nolinger (*) X X X X
1669option originalto X X X X
1670option persist (*) X - X X
1671option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001672option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001673option smtpchk X - X X
1674option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1675option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1676option splice-request (*) X X X X
1677option splice-response (*) X X X X
1678option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1679option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1680-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001681option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001682option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1683option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1684option tcpka X X X X
1685option tcplog X X X X
1686option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001687external-check command X - X X
1688external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001689persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1690rate-limit sessions X X X -
1691redirect - X X X
1692redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1693redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1694reqadd - X X X
1695reqallow - X X X
1696reqdel - X X X
1697reqdeny - X X X
1698reqiallow - X X X
1699reqidel - X X X
1700reqideny - X X X
1701reqipass - X X X
1702reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001703reqitarpit - X X X
1704reqpass - X X X
1705reqrep - X X X
1706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001707reqtarpit - X X X
1708retries X - X X
1709rspadd - X X X
1710rspdel - X X X
1711rspdeny - X X X
1712rspidel - X X X
1713rspideny - X X X
1714rspirep - X X X
1715rsprep - X X X
1716server - - X X
1717source X - X X
1718srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001719stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001720stats auth X - X X
1721stats enable X - X X
1722stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001723stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724stats realm X - X X
1725stats refresh X - X X
1726stats scope X - X X
1727stats show-desc X - X X
1728stats show-legends X - X X
1729stats show-node X - X X
1730stats uri X - X X
1731-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1732stick match - - X X
1733stick on - - X X
1734stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001735stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001736stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001737tcp-check connect - - X X
1738tcp-check expect - - X X
1739tcp-check send - - X X
1740tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001741tcp-request connection - X X -
1742tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001743tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001744tcp-response content - - X X
1745tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001746timeout check X - X X
1747timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001748timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001749timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1750timeout connect X - X X
1751timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1752timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1753timeout http-request X X X X
1754timeout queue X - X X
1755timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001756timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001757timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1758timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001759timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001760transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001761unique-id-format X X X -
1762unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001763use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001764use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001765------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1766 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1770---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
1772This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1773
1774
1775acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1776 Declare or complete an access list.
1777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1778 no | yes | yes | yes
1779 Example:
1780 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1781 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1782 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001784 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
1786
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001787appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1788 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1791 no | no | yes | yes
1792 Arguments :
1793 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1794 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1795
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001796 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797 checked in each cookie value.
1798
1799 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1800 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1801 milliseconds.
1802
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001803 request-learn
1804 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1805 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1806 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1807 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1808 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1809 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1810
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001811 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1812 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1813 data following this prefix.
1814
1815 Example :
1816 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1817
1818 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1819 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1820
1821 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1822 2 modes are currently supported :
1823 - path-parameters :
1824 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1825 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1826 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1827 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1828 - query-string :
1829 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1830 query string.
1831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1833 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1834 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1835 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001836 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1837 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1838 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1840 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1841
1842 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1843
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001844 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1845 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1846 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 Example :
1849 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1850
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001851 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1852 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853
1854
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001855backlog <conns>
1856 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1858 yes | yes | yes | no
1859 Arguments :
1860 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1861 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001862 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001863
1864 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1865 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1866 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1867 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1868 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1869 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1870 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1871 backlog parameter.
1872
1873 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1874 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1875 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1876
1877 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1878
1879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001881balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001882 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1884 yes | no | yes | yes
1885 Arguments :
1886 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1887 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1888 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1889 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1890
1891 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1892 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1893 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1894 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001895 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001896 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001897 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1898 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1899 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1900 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1901 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1902 it, so that you don't worry.
1903
1904 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1905 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1906 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1907 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1908 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1909 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1910 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1911 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001913 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1914 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1915 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1916 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1917 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1918 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1919 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1920 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1921
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001922 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001923 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001924 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1925 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001926 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001927 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1928 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1929 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1930 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1931 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001932 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1933 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1934 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1935 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1936 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1937 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1940 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1941 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1942 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1943 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1944 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1945 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1946 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001947 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001949 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1950 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1951 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001953 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1954 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1955 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1956 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1957 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1958 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1959 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1960 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1961 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1962 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1963 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1964 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001966 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001967 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1968 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1969 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1970 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1971 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1972 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1973 URIs start with a leading "/".
1974
1975 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1976 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1977 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1978 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001981 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1982
1983 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001984 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1985 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001986 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1987 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1988 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1989 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001990 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001991 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1992 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001993
1994 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1995 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1996 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1997 server will receive the request.
1998
1999 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2000 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2001 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2002 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2003 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002004 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2005 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2006 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002008 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2009 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2010 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2011 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2012 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002014 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002015 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2016 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2017 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2018
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002019 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2020 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2021 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2022
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002023 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002024 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002025 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2026 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2027 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2028 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2029 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2030 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002031 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002032 used instead.
2033
2034 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2035 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2036 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2037 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2038
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002039 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2040 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2041 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2042
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002043 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002046 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2047 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002048
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002049 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2050 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2051 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
2053 Examples :
2054 balance roundrobin
2055 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002056 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002057 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2058 balance hdr(host)
2059 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002060
2061 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2062 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002064 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002065 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2066 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2067 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2068 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2069
2070 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2071 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2072 defaults to 16 kB.
2073
2074 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2075 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2076
2077 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2078 Round Robin.
2079
2080 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2081 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2082 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2083 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2084
2085 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2086
2087 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002088 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002089 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2090 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2091 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002093 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2094 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
2096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002097bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2098bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 no | yes | yes | no
2102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002103 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2104 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2105 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2106 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002107 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002108 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2109 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2110 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2111 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2112 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2113 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2114 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002115 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2116 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2117 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2118 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2119 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2120 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2121 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002122 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2123 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2124 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002125 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2126 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2127 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002128
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002129 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2130 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002131 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2132 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2133 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002134 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2135 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2136 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2137 the range.
2138
2139 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2140 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2141 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2142 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2143 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2144 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2145 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002146 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002147 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002149 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2150 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2151 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2152 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2153 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2154 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2155 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2156 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002158 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2159 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2160 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2161 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2164 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2165 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2166 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2167 in a frontend.
2168
2169 Example :
2170 listen http_proxy
2171 bind :80,:443
2172 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002173 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002175 listen http_https_proxy
2176 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002177 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002178
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002179 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2180 bind ipv6@:80
2181 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2182 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2183
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002184 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002185 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002186
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002187 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002188 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189
2190
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002191bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002192 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | yes | yes | yes
2195 Arguments :
2196 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2197 may be used to override a default value.
2198
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002199 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002200 option may be combined with other numbers.
2201
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002202 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002203 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2204 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2205 missing from all processes.
2206
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002207 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002208 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002209 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2210 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2211 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2212 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002213
2214 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2215 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2216 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2217 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2218 and 'even' instances.
2219
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002220 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2221 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2222 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2223 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002224
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002225 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2226 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2227
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002228 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2229 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2230 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2231
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002232 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2233 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2234
2235 Example :
2236 listen app_ip1
2237 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002238 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002239
2240 listen app_ip2
2241 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002242 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002243
2244 listen management
2245 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002246 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002247
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002248 listen management
2249 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2250 bind-process 1-4
2251
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002252 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002253
2254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255block { if | unless } <condition>
2256 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2258 no | yes | yes | yes
2259
2260 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2261 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002262 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002263 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2265 "block" statements per instance.
2266
2267 Example:
2268 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2269 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2270 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2271 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002273 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275
2276capture cookie <name> len <length>
2277 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2279 no | yes | yes | no
2280 Arguments :
2281 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2282 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2283 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2284 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2285 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2286
2287 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2288 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2289 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2290 right if it exceeds <length>.
2291
2292 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2293 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2294 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2295 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2296
2297 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2298 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2299 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2300
2301 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2302 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2303 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002304 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2305 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2306 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308 Example:
2309 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2310
2311 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002312 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313
2314
2315capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002316 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2318 no | yes | yes | no
2319 Arguments :
2320 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002321 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2323 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2324 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2325
2326 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2327 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2328 it exceeds <length>.
2329
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002330 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2332 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002333 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2334 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2335 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2336 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002337 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002338 environments to find where the request came from.
2339
2340 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2341 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2342 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2343 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002344
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002345 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2346 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2347 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2348 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2349 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350
2351 Example:
2352 capture request header Host len 15
2353 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2354 capture request header Referrer len 15
2355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002356 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 about logging.
2358
2359
2360capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002361 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2363 no | yes | yes | no
2364 Arguments :
2365 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002366 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2368 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2369 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2370
2371 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2372 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2373 it exceeds <length>.
2374
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002375 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2377 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2378 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002379 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2380 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2381 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2382 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002384 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2385 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2386 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2387 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2388 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
2390 Example:
2391 capture response header Content-length len 9
2392 capture response header Location len 15
2393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002394 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395 about logging.
2396
2397
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002398clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2401 yes | yes | yes | no
2402 Arguments :
2403 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2405 as explained at the top of this document.
2406
2407 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2408 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2409 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2410 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2411 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2412 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2413 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2414 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002415 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2417 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2418
2419 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2420 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2421 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2422 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2423 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2424 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2425
2426 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2427 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2428
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002429 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2430 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002432compression algo <algorithm> ...
2433compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002434compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002435 Enable HTTP compression.
2436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2437 yes | yes | yes | yes
2438 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002439 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2440 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2441 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2442
2443 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002444 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2445 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2446 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002447
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002448 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2449 support for zlib was built in.
2450
2451 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2452 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2453 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2454 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2455 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2456 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002457
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002458 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2459 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2460 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2461 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2462 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2463 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2464 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2465 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002466
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002467 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002468 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002469 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2470 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2471 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2472 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2473 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002474
2475 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2476 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2477 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2478 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2479 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002480 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2481 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2482 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2483 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2484 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002485 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2486 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002487
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002488 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002489 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2490 "Accept-Encoding" header
2491 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002492 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002493 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2494 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002495 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2496 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2497 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2498 "multipart"
2499 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2500 header
2501 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2502 and later
2503 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2504 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002505
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002506 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2507 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002508
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002509 Examples :
2510 compression algo gzip
2511 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002513contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2516 yes | no | yes | yes
2517 Arguments :
2518 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2520 as explained at the top of this document.
2521
2522 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002523 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002524 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2526 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2527 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2528 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2538 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2539 instead.
2540
2541 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2542 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2543
2544
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002545cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002546 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2547 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2550 yes | no | yes | yes
2551 Arguments :
2552 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2553 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2554 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2555 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2556 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2557 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2558 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2559 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2560 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2561
2562 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2563 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2564 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2565 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2566 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2567 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2568 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2569 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2570 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2571 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2572 "insert" and "prefix".
2573
2574 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002575 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002576
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002577 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002578 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2579 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2580 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2581 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2582 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2583 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2584 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2585 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2586 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2587 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
2589 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2590 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2591 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2592 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2593 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2594 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2595 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2596 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2597 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2598 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002599 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2600 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2601 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002603 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2604 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2605 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002606 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2607 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2608 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2609 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002610 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2611 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2612 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613
2614 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2615 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2616 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2617 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2618 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2619 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2620 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2621 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2622 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2623
2624 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2625 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2626 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2627 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2628 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2629 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2630 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2631 persistence cookie in the cache.
2632 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2633
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002634 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2635 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2636 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2637 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2638 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2639 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2640 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2641 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2642 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2643 they logout.
2644
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002645 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2646 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2647 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2648 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2649
2650 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2651 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2652 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2653 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2654 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2655 this attribute.
2656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002657 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002658 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002659 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2660 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2661 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2662 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2663 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2664 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002666 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2667 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2668 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2669 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2670 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2671 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2672 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2673 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2674 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2675 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2676 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2677 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2678 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2679 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2680 the site.
2681
2682 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2683 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2684 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2685 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2686 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2687 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2688 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2689 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2690 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2691 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2692 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2693 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2694 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2695 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2696 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2697 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2698
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2700 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2701 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2702 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704 Examples :
2705 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2706 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2707 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002708 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002710 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002711 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002713
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002714declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2715 Declares a capture slot.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 no | yes | yes | no
2718 Arguments:
2719 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2720
2721 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2722 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2723 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2724 for use in the response.
2725
2726 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2727 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2728
2729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002730default-server [param*]
2731 Change default options for a server in a backend
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 yes | no | yes | yes
2734 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002735 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2736 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2737 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2738 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002739
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002740 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002741 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2742
2743 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746default_backend <backend>
2747 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2749 yes | yes | yes | no
2750 Arguments :
2751 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2752
2753 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2754 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2755 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2756 will catch all undetermined requests.
2757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 Example :
2759
2760 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2761 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2762 default_backend dynamic
2763
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002764 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002767description <string>
2768 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 no | yes | yes | yes
2771 Arguments : string
2772
2773 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2774 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2775 it describes.
2776 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2777
2778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779disabled
2780 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2782 yes | yes | yes | yes
2783 Arguments : none
2784
2785 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2786 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2787 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2788 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2789 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2790 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2791 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2792
2793 See also : "enabled"
2794
2795
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002796dispatch <address>:<port>
2797 Set a default server address
2798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2799 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002801
2802 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2803 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2804 during start-up.
2805
2806 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2807 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2808 possible with normal servers.
2809
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002810 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002811 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2812 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2813 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2814 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2815
2816 See also : "server"
2817
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819enabled
2820 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2822 yes | yes | yes | yes
2823 Arguments : none
2824
2825 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2826 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2827
2828 See also : "disabled"
2829
2830
2831errorfile <code> <file>
2832 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 yes | yes | yes | yes
2835 Arguments :
2836 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002837 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2838 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
2840 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002841 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002843 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2844 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
2846 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2847 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2848 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002850 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2853 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2854 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2855 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2856
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002857 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2858 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2859 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2860 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2861 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2862 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2865 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2866 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002867 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2869
2870 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2871
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002872 Example :
2873 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002874 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002875 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2876 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2877
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002878
2879errorloc <code> <url>
2880errorloc302 <code> <url>
2881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 yes | yes | yes | yes
2884 Arguments :
2885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002886 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002887
2888 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2889 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2890 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2891 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2892 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2893
2894 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2895 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2896 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2897
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002898 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002900 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2901 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2902 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2903 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2904 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2905 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2906 request.
2907
2908 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2909
2910
2911errorloc303 <code> <url>
2912 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2914 yes | yes | yes | yes
2915 Arguments :
2916 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2917 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2918
2919 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2920 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2921 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2922 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2923 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2924
2925 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2926 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2927 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2928
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002929 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2930
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002931 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2932 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2933 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2934 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002935 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002936
2937 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2938
2939
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002940email-alert from <emailaddr>
2941 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2942 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2944 yes | yes | yes | yes
2945
2946 Arguments :
2947
2948 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2949
2950 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2951 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2952
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002953 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2954 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2955
2956
2957email-alert level <level>
2958 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2959 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | yes | yes | yes
2962
2963 Arguments :
2964
2965 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2966 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2967 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2968
2969 By default level is alert
2970
2971 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2972 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2973 for the proxy.
2974
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002975 Alerts are sent when :
2976
2977 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2978 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2979 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2980 is notice or lower
2981 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2982 and a health check status update occurs
2983
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002984 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2985 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002986 section 3.6 about mailers.
2987
2988
2989email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2990 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2992 yes | yes | yes | yes
2993
2994 Arguments :
2995
2996 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2997
2998 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2999 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3000
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003001 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3002 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003003
3004
3005email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3006 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3007 mailers.
3008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 yes | yes | yes | yes
3010
3011 Arguments :
3012
3013 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3014
3015 By default the systems hostname is used.
3016
3017 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3018 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3019 for the proxy.
3020
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003021 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3022 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003023
3024
3025email-alert to <emailaddr>
3026 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3027 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 yes | yes | yes | yes
3030
3031 Arguments :
3032
3033 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3034
3035 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3036 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3037
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003038 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003039 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3040
3041
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003042force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3043 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3045 no | yes | yes | yes
3046
3047 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3048 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3049 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3050 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3051 marked down for maintenance operations.
3052
3053 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3054 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3055 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3056 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3057 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3058 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3059 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3060 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3061 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3062
3063 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3064 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3065 is used.
3066
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003067 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003068 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003069
3070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003071fullconn <conns>
3072 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | no | yes | yes
3075 Arguments :
3076 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3077 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3078
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003079 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003080 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003081 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003082 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3083 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3084 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3085 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3086 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003087 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003088
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003089 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3090 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003091 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3092 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3093 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003095 Example :
3096 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3097 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3098 # connections.
3099 backend dynamic
3100 fullconn 10000
3101 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3102 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3103
3104 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3105
3106
3107grace <time>
3108 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003111 Arguments :
3112 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3113 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3114 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3115
3116 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3117 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003118 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003119 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3120
3121 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3122 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3123 simplify it.
3124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003126hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003127 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3129 yes | no | yes | yes
3130 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003131 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3132 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003133
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003134 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3135 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3136 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3137 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3138 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3139 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3140 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3141 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3142 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3143 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003144
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003145 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3146 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3147 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3148 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3149 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3150 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3151 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3152 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3153 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3154 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3155 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3156 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3157 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003158 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3159 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003160
3161 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3162
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003163 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003164 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3165 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3166 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003167 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3168 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3169 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003170
3171 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3172 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003173 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3174 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3175 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3176 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3177
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003178 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3179 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3180 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3181 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3182 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3183 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3184 parameter.
3185
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003186 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3187 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3188 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3189 used on strings.
3190
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003191 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3192
3193 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3194 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3195 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3196 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3197 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3198 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3199 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3200 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3201 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3202 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3203 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3204 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003205
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003206 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3207 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3208 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003209
3210 See also : "balance", "server"
3211
3212
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003213http-check disable-on-404
3214 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217 Arguments : none
3218
3219 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3220 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3221 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3222 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3223 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3224 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3225 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3226 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003227 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3228 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3229 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3230
3231 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3232
3233
3234http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003235 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003237 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003238 Arguments :
3239 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3240 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003241 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003242 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3243 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3244 details on the supported keywords.
3245
3246 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3247 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3248 with the usual backslash ('\').
3249
3250 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3251 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3252 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3253 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3254 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3255
3256 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003258 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3259 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3260 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3261
3262 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003263 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003264 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3265 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3266 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3267 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3268
3269 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003271 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3272 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3273 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3274 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3275 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3276 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3277 trace).
3278
3279 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003281 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3282 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3283 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3284 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3285 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3286 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3287
3288 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3289 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3290 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3291 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3292 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3293 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3294 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3295 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3296
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003297 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3298 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3299 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003301 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3302 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3303
3304 Examples :
3305 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003306 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003307
3308 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003309 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003310
3311 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003312 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003313
3314 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003315 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003317 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318
3319
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003320http-check send-state
3321 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | no | yes | yes
3324 Arguments : none
3325
3326 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3327 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3328 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3329 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3330 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3331
3332 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3333 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3334 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3335 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3336 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003337 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3338 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3339 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3340
3341 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3342 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3343 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3344
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003345 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3346 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3347 checked in multiple backends.
3348
3349 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3350 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3351
3352 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3353 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3354 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3355 one fails.
3356
3357 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3358 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3359 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3360
3361 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3362 server's queue.
3363
3364 Example of a header received by the application server :
3365 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3366 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3367
3368 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3369
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003370http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003371 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003372 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003373 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003374 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3375 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003376 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3377 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003378 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3379 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3380 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003381 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003382 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003383 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3384 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003385 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003387 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3388
3389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 no | yes | yes | yes
3391
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003392 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3393 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3394 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3395 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3396 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003397
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003398 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3399 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3400 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3401
3402 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3403 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3404 are evaluated.
3405
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003406 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3407 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3408 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3409 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3410 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3411 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3412 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3413 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3414 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003415 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003416 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3417
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003418 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3419 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3420 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3421 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3422 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3423
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003424 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3425 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3426 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003427 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3428 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003429
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003430 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3431 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3432 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3433 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3434 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3435 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3436 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3437 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3438
3439 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3440 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3441 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003442 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3443 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003444
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003445 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3446 <name>.
3447
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003448 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3449 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3450 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3451 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3452 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3453 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3454 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3455 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3456
3457 Example:
3458
3459 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3460
3461 applied to:
3462
3463 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3464
3465 outputs:
3466
3467 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3468
3469 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3470
3471 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3472 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3473 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3474 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3475 header.
3476
3477 Example:
3478
3479 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3480
3481 applied to:
3482
3483 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3484
3485 outputs:
3486
3487 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3488
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003489 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3490 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3491 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3492 it.
3493
3494 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3495 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3496 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3497 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3498 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3499 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3500
3501 Example :
3502 # prepend the host name before the path
3503 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3504
3505 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3506 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3507 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3508 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3509 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3510 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3511 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3512 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3513
3514 Example :
3515 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3516 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3517
3518 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3519 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3520 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3521 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3522 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3523 "set-query".
3524
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003525 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3526 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3527 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3528 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3529 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3530 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3531 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3532 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3533
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003534 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3535 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3536 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3537 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3538 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3539 another equipment.
3540
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003541 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3542 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3543 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3544 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3545 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3546 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3547 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3548 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3549
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003550 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3551 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3552 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3553 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3554 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3555 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3556 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3557 admin privileges.
3558
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003559 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3560 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3561 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3562 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3563 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3564 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3565 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3566 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3567
3568 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3569 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3570 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3571 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3572 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3573 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3574
3575 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3576 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3577 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3578 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3579 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3580 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3581
3582 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3583 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3584 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3585 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3586 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3587 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3588 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3589 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3590 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3591
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003592 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003593 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3594 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3595 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3596 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3597 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3598 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3599 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3600 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3601 request header" for more information.
3602
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003603 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3604 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3605 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3606 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3607
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003608 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3609 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3610 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3611 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3612 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3613 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3614 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3615 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3616 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3617 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3618 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3619 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3620
3621 These actions take one or two arguments :
3622 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3623 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3624 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3625 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3626
3627 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3628 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3629 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3630 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3631
3632 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3633 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3634 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3635 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3636 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3637 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3638 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3639 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3640
3641 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3642 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3643 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3644 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3645 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3646
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003647 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3648 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3649 function is documented in the API documentation.
3650
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003651 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3652 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3653 inline.
3654
3655 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3656 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3657 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3658 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3659 (request and response)
3660 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3661 processing
3662 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3663 processing.
3664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3666 and '_'.
3667
3668 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3669 followed by some converters.
3670
3671 Example:
3672
3673 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3674
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003675 - set-src <expr> :
3676 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3677 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3678 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3679 source IP for privacy.
3680
3681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3682 followed by some converters.
3683
3684 Example:
3685
3686 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3687 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3688
3689 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3690
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003691 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3692
3693 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3694 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3695 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3696 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003697
3698 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003699 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3700 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3701 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003702
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003703 http-request allow if nagios
3704 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3705 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3706 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003707
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003708 Example:
3709 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003710 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003711
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003712 Example:
3713 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3714 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3715 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3716 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3717 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3718 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3719 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3720 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3721 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3722
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003723 Example:
3724 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3725 acl add path /addacl
3726 acl del path /delacl
3727
3728 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3729
3730 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3731 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3732
3733 Example:
3734 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3735 acl setmap path /setmap
3736 acl delmap path /delmap
3737
3738 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3739
3740 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3741 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3742
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003743 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3744 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003745
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003746http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003747 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003748 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003749 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3750 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003751 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3752 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3753 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3754 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003755 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003756 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003757 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003758 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003759 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003760 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3761
3762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 no | yes | yes | yes
3764
3765 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3766 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3767 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3768 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3769 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3770 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3771
3772 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3773 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3774 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3775 current section.
3776
3777 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3778 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3779 rules are evaluated.
3780
3781 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3782 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3783 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3784 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3785 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3786 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3787 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3788
3789 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3790 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3791 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3792 external users.
3793
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003794 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3795 <name>.
3796
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003797 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3798 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3799 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3800 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3801 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3802 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3803 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3804 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3805
3806 Example:
3807
3808 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3809
3810 applied to:
3811
3812 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3813
3814 outputs:
3815
3816 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3817
3818 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3819
3820 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3821 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3822 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3823 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3824 header.
3825
3826 Example:
3827
3828 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3829
3830 applied to:
3831
3832 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3833
3834 outputs:
3835
3836 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3837
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003838 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3839 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3840 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3841 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3842 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3843 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3844 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3845 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3846
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003847 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3848 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3849 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3850 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3851 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3852 another equipment.
3853
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003854 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3855 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3856 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3857 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3858 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3859 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3860 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3861 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3862
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003863 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3864 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3865 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3866 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3867 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3868 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3869 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3870 admin privileges.
3871
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003872 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3873 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3874 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3875 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3876 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3877 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3878 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3879 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3880
3881 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3882 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3883 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3884 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3885 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3886 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3887
3888 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3889 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3890 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3891 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3892 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3893 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3894
3895 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3896 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3897 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3898 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3899 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3900 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3901 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3902 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3903 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3904
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003905 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3906 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3907 function is documented in the API documentation.
3908
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003909 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3910 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3911 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3912 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3913 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3914 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3915 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3916 response header" for more information.
3917
3918 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3919 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3920 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3921 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3922 keyword.
3923
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003924 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3925 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3926 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3927 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3928 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3929 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3930
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003931 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3932 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3933 inline.
3934
3935 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3936 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3937 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3938 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3939 (request and response)
3940 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3941 processing
3942 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3943 processing.
3944 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3945 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3946 and '_'.
3947
3948 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3949 followed by some converters.
3950
3951 Example:
3952
3953 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3954
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003955 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3956
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003957 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003958 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3959 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3960 rules.
3961
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003962 Example:
3963 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3964
3965 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3966
3967 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3968 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3969
3970 Example:
3971 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3972
3973 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3974
3975 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3976 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3977
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003978 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3979 ACL usage.
3980
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003981
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003982http-send-name-header [<header>]
3983 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3984
3985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | no | yes | yes
3987
3988 Arguments :
3989
3990 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3991
3992 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3993 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3994 is added with the header string proved.
3995
3996 See also : "server"
3997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003998id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003999 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 no | yes | yes | yes
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4005 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4006 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004007
4008
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004009ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4010 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 no | yes | yes | yes
4013
4014 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4015 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4016 and running).
4017
4018 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4019 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4020 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004021 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004022 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4023
4024 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
4025 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
4026
4027 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4028 "unless" condition is met.
4029
4030 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4031
4032
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004033log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004034log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004035no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004039
4040 Prefix :
4041 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4042 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4043 prefix does not allow arguments.
4044
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004045 Arguments :
4046 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4047 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4048 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4049 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4050 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4051 parameter.
4052
4053 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4054 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4055
4056 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4057 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4058 standard syslog port).
4059
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004060 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4061 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4062 standard syslog port).
4063
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004064 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4065 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4066 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4067 appropriately writeable).
4068
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004069 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4070 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004071
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004072 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4073 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4074 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4075 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4076 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4077 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4078 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4079 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4080 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4081 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4082 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4083
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004084 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4085
4086 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4087 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4088 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4089
4090 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4091 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4092 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004093 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4094 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4095 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4096 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4097 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004098
4099 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4100
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004101 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4102 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4103 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004104
4105 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4106 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4107 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4108 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4109
4110 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4111 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112
4113 Example :
4114 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004115 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4116 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004117 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004118
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004119
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004120log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004121 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4122 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004124
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004125 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4126 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4127 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4128 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4129 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004130
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004131log-tag <string>
4132 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4133 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | yes
4135
4136 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4137 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4138 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4139 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4140 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4141 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4142 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4143 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4144 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004145
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004146max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4147 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | no | yes | yes
4150
4151 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4152 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4153 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4154 servers.
4155
4156 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4157 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4158 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4159 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4160 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4161 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4162 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4163 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4164 picking a different server.
4165
4166 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4167 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4168 even if they have to be queued.
4169
4170 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4171 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4172
4173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004174maxconn <conns>
4175 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4177 yes | yes | yes | no
4178 Arguments :
4179 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4180 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4181 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4182 closes.
4183
4184 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4185 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4186 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4187 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4188 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4189 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4190 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4191 properly tuned.
4192
4193 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4194 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4195 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4196
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004197 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4198
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004199 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4200
4201
4202mode { tcp|http|health }
4203 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 yes | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4208 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4209 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4210 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4211
4212 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4213 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4214 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4215 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4216 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4217
4218 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004219 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4220 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4221 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4222 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4223 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4224 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4225 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004227 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4228 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4229 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004230
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004231 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004232 defaults http_instances
4233 mode http
4234
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004235 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004238monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004239 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242 Arguments :
4243 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4244 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004245 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4247 backend and its backup.
4248
4249 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4250 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4251 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4252 servers in a list of backends.
4253
4254 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4255 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4256 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4257 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4258 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4259 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4260 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004261 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4262 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263
4264 Example:
4265 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004266 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4268 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4269 monitor-uri /site_alive
4270 monitor fail if site_dead
4271
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004272 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004273
4274
4275monitor-net <source>
4276 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 yes | yes | yes | no
4279 Arguments :
4280 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4281 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4282 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4283 followed by a mask.
4284
4285 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4286 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004287 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004288 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4289
4290 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4291 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4292 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4293 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004294 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4295 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4296 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004297
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004298 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4299 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4300 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4301 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4302 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4303 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004304
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004305 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4306 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004307
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004308 Example :
4309 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4310 frontend www
4311 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4312
4313 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4314
4315
4316monitor-uri <uri>
4317 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | no
4320 Arguments :
4321 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4322 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4323
4324 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4325 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4326 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4327 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4328 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4329 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4330 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4331 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4332
4333 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4334 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4335 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4336 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4337 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4338 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4339
4340 Example :
4341 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4342 frontend www
4343 mode http
4344 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4345
4346 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004349option abortonclose
4350no option abortonclose
4351 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4353 yes | no | yes | yes
4354 Arguments : none
4355
4356 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4357 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4358 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4359 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004360 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004361 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4362 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4363 encountered while delivering the response.
4364
4365 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4366 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4367 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4368 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4369 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4370 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004371 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004372 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004373 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004374 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4375 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4376 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4377
4378 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4379 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4380 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4381 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4382 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4383 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4384 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4385 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004386 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004387
4388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4390
4391 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4392
4393
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004394option accept-invalid-http-request
4395no option accept-invalid-http-request
4396 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 yes | yes | yes | no
4399 Arguments : none
4400
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004401 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004402 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4403 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4404 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4405 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4406 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4407 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4408 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004409 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4410 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4411 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4412 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4413 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004414 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004415 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4416 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4417 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004418
4419 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4420 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4421 been confirmed.
4422
4423 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4424 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004425 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4426 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004427 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4428
4429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4431
4432 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4433 stats socket.
4434
4435
4436option accept-invalid-http-response
4437no option accept-invalid-http-response
4438 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4440 yes | no | yes | yes
4441 Arguments : none
4442
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004443 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004444 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4445 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4446 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4447 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4448 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4449 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4450 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004451 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4452 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4453 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004454
4455 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4456 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4457 been confirmed.
4458
4459 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4460 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4461 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4462 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4463
4464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4466
4467 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4468 stats socket.
4469
4470
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004471option allbackups
4472no option allbackups
4473 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 yes | no | yes | yes
4476 Arguments : none
4477
4478 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4479 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4480 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4481 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4482 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4483 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4484 order between the backup servers anymore.
4485
4486 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4487 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4488
4489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4491
4492
4493option checkcache
4494no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004495 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
4498 Arguments : none
4499
4500 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4501 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004502 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004503 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4504 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004505 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004506
4507 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004508 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004509 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004510 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4511 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004512 to the client are :
4513 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004514 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004515 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004516 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4517 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4518 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4519 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4520 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4521 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4522 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4523 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4524 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4525 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4526 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4527
4528 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004529 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004530 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004531 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004532 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4533
4534 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4535 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004536 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004537 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4538
4539 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4540 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4541
4542
4543option clitcpka
4544no option clitcpka
4545 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 yes | yes | yes | no
4548 Arguments : none
4549
4550 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4551 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4552 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4553 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4554
4555 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4556 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4557 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4558 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4559
4560 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4561 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4562 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4563 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4564 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4565
4566 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4567
4568 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4569 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4570 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4571
4572 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4573 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4574
4575 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4576
4577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004578option contstats
4579 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | yes | yes | no
4582 Arguments : none
4583
4584 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4585 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4586 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4587 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4588 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4589 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4590 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4591
4592
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004593option dontlog-normal
4594no option dontlog-normal
4595 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | yes | yes | no
4598 Arguments : none
4599
4600 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4601 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4602 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4603 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4604 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4605 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4606 logged.
4607
4608 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4609 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4610 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004612 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004613 logging.
4614
4615
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004616option dontlognull
4617no option dontlognull
4618 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | no
4621 Arguments : none
4622
4623 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4624 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4625 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4626 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4627 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4628 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004629 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4630 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4631 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004632
4633 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4634 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4635 would not be logged.
4636
4637 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4638 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4639
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004640 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4641 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004642
4643
4644option forceclose
4645no option forceclose
4646 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004649 Arguments : none
4650
4651 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4652 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4653 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4654 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4655 global session times in the logs.
4656
4657 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004658 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004659 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004660
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004661 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4662 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4663 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4664
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004665 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4666 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004667
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4670
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004671 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004672
4673
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004674option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004675 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | yes | yes | yes
4678 Arguments :
4679 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4680 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004681 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004682 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004683
4684 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4685 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4686 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4687 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4688 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4689 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4690 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004691 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4692 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4693 possible that the client has already brought one.
4694
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004695 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004696 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004697 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4698 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004699 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4700 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004701
4702 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4703 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4704 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4705 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4706 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4707 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4708 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4709
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004710 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4711 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4712 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4713 are under the control of the end-user.
4714
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004715 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004716 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4717 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004718 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4719 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4720 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004721
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004722 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004723 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4724 frontend www
4725 mode http
4726 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4727
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004728 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4729 backend www
4730 mode http
4731 option forwardfor header X-Client
4732
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004733 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004734 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004735
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004736
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004737option http-buffer-request
4738no option http-buffer-request
4739 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | yes
4742 Arguments : none
4743
4744 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4745 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4746 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4747 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4748 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4749 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4750 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4751 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4752 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4753 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4754 default.
4755
4756 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4757
4758
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004759option http-ignore-probes
4760no option http-ignore-probes
4761 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | no
4764 Arguments : none
4765
4766 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4767 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4768 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4769 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4770 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4771 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4772 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4773 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4774 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4775 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4776 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4777 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4778
4779 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4780 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4781 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4782 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4783 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4784 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4785 are often the only way to detect them.
4786
4787 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4788 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4789
4790 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4791
4792
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004793option http-keep-alive
4794no option http-keep-alive
4795 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | yes | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004800 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4801 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4802 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4803 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4804 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4805 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4806 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4807
4808 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4809 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004810 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4811 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4812 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4813 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4814 situations where this option may be useful :
4815
4816 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4817 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4818
4819 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4820 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4821
4822 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4823 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4824 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4825 request.
4826
4827 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4828 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004829 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4830 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4831 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004832
4833 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4834 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4835
4836 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4837 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4838 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4839 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4840 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4841 not set.
4842
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004843 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4844 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004845 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004846 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004847
4848 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004849 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4850 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004851
4852
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004853option http-no-delay
4854no option http-no-delay
4855 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | yes
4858 Arguments : none
4859
4860 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4861 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4862 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4863 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4864 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4865 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4866 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4867 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4868 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4869 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4870 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4871 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4872 affected.
4873
4874 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4875 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4876 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4877 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4878 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4879 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4880 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4881 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4882 latency environments.
4883
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004884 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4885
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004886
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004887option http-pretend-keepalive
4888no option http-pretend-keepalive
4889 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4891 yes | yes | yes | yes
4892 Arguments : none
4893
4894 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4895 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4896 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4897 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4898 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4899 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4900 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4901 consider the response complete.
4902
4903 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4904 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4905 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4906 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4907 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4908 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4909
4910 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4911 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4912 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4913 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4914 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4915 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4916 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4917
4918 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4919 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004920 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004921 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4922 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004923
4924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4926
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004927 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4928 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004929
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004930
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004931option http-server-close
4932no option http-server-close
4933 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4935 yes | yes | yes | yes
4936 Arguments : none
4937
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004938 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4939 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4940 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4941 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4942 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4943 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4944 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4945 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4946 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4947 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4948 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4949 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4950 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4951 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4952 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4953 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004954
4955 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4956 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4957 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4958 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004959 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4960 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004961
4962 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4963 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004964 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4965 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004966 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4967 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004968
4969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4971
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004972 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004973 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4974 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004975
4976
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004977option http-tunnel
4978no option http-tunnel
4979 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 yes | yes | yes | yes
4982 Arguments : none
4983
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004984 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4985 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4986 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4987 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4988 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4989 "option http-tunnel".
4990
4991 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004992 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004993 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4994 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4995 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4996 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4997 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4998 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4999 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005000
5001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5003
5004 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5005 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5006 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5007
5008
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005009option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005010no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005011 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | yes | yes | no
5014 Arguments : none
5015
5016 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5017 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5018 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5019 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5020 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5021 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5022 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5023
5024 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5025 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5026 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5027 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5028 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5029 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5030 request along its whole life.
5031
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005032 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5033 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5034 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5035 front of an existing proxy.
5036
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005037 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5038
5039 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5040 http-server-close".
5041
5042
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005043option httpchk
5044option httpchk <uri>
5045option httpchk <method> <uri>
5046option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5047 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | no | yes | yes
5050 Arguments :
5051 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5052 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5053 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5054 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5055 ones.
5056
5057 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5058 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5059 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5060
5061 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5062 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5063 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5064 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5065 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5066
5067 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5068 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5069 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5070 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5071 the lack of any response.
5072
5073 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5074
5075 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5076 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5077 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5078
5079 Examples :
5080 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5081 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5082 backend https_relay
5083 mode tcp
5084 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5085 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5086
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005087 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5088 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5089 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005090
5091
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005092option httpclose
5093no option httpclose
5094 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005099 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5100 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5101 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5102 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005103 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005104 "option http-tunnel".
5105
5106 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5107 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5108 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5109 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5110 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5111 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5112 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5113 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005114
5115 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005116 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005117 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5118 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5119 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5120 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5121 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005122
5123 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5124 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005125 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5126 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005127 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5128 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005129
5130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5132
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005133 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5134 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005135
5136
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005137option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005138 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005141 Arguments :
5142 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5143 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5144 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5145 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5146 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005147
5148 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5149 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5150 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5151 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5152 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5153 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5154 ports.
5155
5156 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5157
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005158 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5159 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005161 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005162
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005163
5164option http_proxy
5165no option http_proxy
5166 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | yes | yes | yes
5169 Arguments : none
5170
5171 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5172 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5173 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5174 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5175 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5176
5177 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5178 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5179 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5180 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005181 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005182 be analyzed.
5183
5184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5186
5187 Example :
5188 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5189 backend direct_forward
5190 option httpclose
5191 option http_proxy
5192
5193 See also : "option httpclose"
5194
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005195
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005196option independent-streams
5197no option independent-streams
5198 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | yes | yes | yes
5201 Arguments : none
5202
5203 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5204 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5205 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5206 receive data or not.
5207
5208 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5209 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5210 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5211 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5212 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5213 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5214 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5215 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5216 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5217 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5218 socket buffers.
5219
5220 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5221 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5222 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5223 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5224 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5225
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005226 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005227 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5228 deprecated.
5229
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005230 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005231
5232
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005233option ldap-check
5234 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237 Arguments : none
5238
5239 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5240 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5241 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5242 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5243
5244 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5245 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5246
5247 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5248 configure it.
5249
5250 Example :
5251 option ldap-check
5252
5253 See also : "option httpchk"
5254
5255
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005256option external-check
5257 Use external processes for server health checks
5258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 yes | no | yes | yes
5260
5261 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5262 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5263 command".
5264
5265 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5266
5267 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5268
5269
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005270option log-health-checks
5271no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005272 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | no | yes | yes
5275 Arguments : none
5276
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005277 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5278 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5279 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005280
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005281 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5282 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5283 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5284 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5285 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5286
5287 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5288 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005289
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005290 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5291 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5292 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005293
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005294
5295option log-separate-errors
5296no option log-separate-errors
5297 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | yes | yes | no
5300 Arguments : none
5301
5302 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5303 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5304 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5305 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5306 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5307 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5308 provides very important information.
5309
5310 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5311 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5312 error logs.
5313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005314 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005315 logging.
5316
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005317
5318option logasap
5319no option logasap
5320 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | yes | yes | no
5323 Arguments : none
5324
5325 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5326 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5327 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5328 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5329 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5330 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5331 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005332 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005333 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5334 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5335
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005336 Examples :
5337 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5338 mode http
5339 option httplog
5340 option logasap
5341 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5342
5343 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5344 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5345 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5346 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005348 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005349 logging.
5350
5351
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005352option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005353 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005356 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005357 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5358 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005359 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005360
5361 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5362 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5363 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5364 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5365 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5366 in the MySQL table, like this :
5367
5368 USE mysql;
5369 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5370 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5371
5372 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5373 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5374 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5375 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5376 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5377 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5378 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5379 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5380 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5381
5382 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5383 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005384
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005385 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005386
5387 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5388 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5389 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5390 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5391 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5392 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5393
5394 See also: "option httpchk"
5395
5396
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005397option nolinger
5398no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005399 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005400 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005402 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005403
5404 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5405 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5406 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5407 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5408 connections.
5409
5410 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5411 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5412 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5413 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5414 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5415 this too.
5416
5417 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5418 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5419 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5420
5421 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5422 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5423 for servers.
5424
5425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5427
5428
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005429option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5430 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5432 yes | yes | yes | yes
5433 Arguments :
5434 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5435 matching <network>
5436 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5437 header name.
5438
5439 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5440 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5441 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5442 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5443 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5444 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5445 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5446 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5447 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5448 possible that the client has already brought one.
5449
5450 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5451 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5452 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5453 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5454 header and requires different one.
5455
5456 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5457 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5458 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5459 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5460 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5461 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5462 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5463
5464 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5465 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5466 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5467 both are defined.
5468
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005469 Examples :
5470 # Original Destination address
5471 frontend www
5472 mode http
5473 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5474
5475 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5476 backend www
5477 mode http
5478 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5479
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005480 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5481 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005482
5483
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005484option persist
5485no option persist
5486 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005489 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005490
5491 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5492 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5493 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5494 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5495 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5496 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5497 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5498 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5499 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5500 redirected to another valid server.
5501
5502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5504
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005505 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005506
5507
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005508option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5509 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 yes | no | yes | yes
5512 Arguments :
5513 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5514 PostgreSQL server.
5515
5516 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5517 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5518 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5519 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5520
5521 See also: "option httpchk"
5522
5523
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005524option prefer-last-server
5525no option prefer-last-server
5526 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 yes | no | yes | yes
5529 Arguments : none
5530
5531 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5532 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5533 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5534 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5535 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5536 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5537 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5538 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5539 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005540 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5541 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5542 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5543 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5544 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5545 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5546 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005547
5548 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5549 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5550
5551 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5552
5553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005554option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005555option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005556no option redispatch
5557 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5559 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005560 Arguments :
5561 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5562 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5563 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5564 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5565 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5566 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5567 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5568 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5569 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005571
5572 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5573 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5574 be able to access the service anymore.
5575
5576 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5577 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5578
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005579 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005580 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5581 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005583 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5584 "redisp" keywords.
5585
5586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5588
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005589 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005590
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005591
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005592option redis-check
5593 Use redis health checks for server testing
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | no | yes | yes
5596 Arguments : none
5597
5598 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5599 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5600 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5601 find the "+PONG" response message.
5602
5603 Example :
5604 option redis-check
5605
5606 See also : "option httpchk"
5607
5608
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005609option smtpchk
5610option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5611 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005614 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005615 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5616 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5617 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5618
5619 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5620 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5621 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5622
5623 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5624 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5625 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5626 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5627 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5628 dead server.
5629
5630 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5631 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5632 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5633 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5634
5635 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5636 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5637 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5638 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5639 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5640
5641 Example :
5642 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5643
5644 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005647option socket-stats
5648no option socket-stats
5649
5650 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | yes | yes | no
5653
5654 Arguments : none
5655
5656
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005657option splice-auto
5658no option splice-auto
5659 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 yes | yes | yes | yes
5662 Arguments : none
5663
5664 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5665 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5666 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5667 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005668 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005669 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5670 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5671 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5672 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5673
5674 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5675 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5676 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5677 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5678 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5679 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5680 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5681 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5682 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5683 keyword.
5684
5685 Example :
5686 option splice-auto
5687
5688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5690
5691 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5692 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5693
5694
5695option splice-request
5696no option splice-request
5697 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments : none
5701
5702 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005703 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005704 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5705 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5706 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5707 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5708
5709 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5710
5711 Example :
5712 option splice-request
5713
5714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5716
5717 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5718 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5719
5720
5721option splice-response
5722no option splice-response
5723 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | yes | yes | yes
5726 Arguments : none
5727
5728 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005729 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005730 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5731 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5732 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5733 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5734
5735 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5736
5737 Example :
5738 option splice-response
5739
5740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5742
5743 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5744 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5745
5746
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005747option srvtcpka
5748no option srvtcpka
5749 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | no | yes | yes
5752 Arguments : none
5753
5754 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5755 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5756 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5757 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5758
5759 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5760 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5761 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5762 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5763
5764 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5765 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5766 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5767 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5768 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5769
5770 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5771
5772 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5773 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5774 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5775
5776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5778
5779 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5780
5781
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005782option ssl-hello-chk
5783 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | no | yes | yes
5786 Arguments : none
5787
5788 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5789 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5790 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5791 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5792 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5793 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5794 hello message.
5795
5796 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5797 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5798 messages, which is appreciable.
5799
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005800 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5801 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5802 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005803
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005804 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005806
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005807option tcp-check
5808 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811
5812 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5813 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5814
5815 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5816 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5817 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5818
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005819 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005820 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5821 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5822 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5823 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5824 only.
5825
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005826 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005827 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5828 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5829 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5830 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5831
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005832 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005833 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5834 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005835 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005836 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5837 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5838 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5839 the respective protocols.
5840 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5841 analysed.
5842
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005843 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5844 script.
5845
5846 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5847 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5848 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5849 The "comment" is of course optional.
5850
5851
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005852 Examples :
5853 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5854 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005855 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005856
5857 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5858 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005859 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005860
5861 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5862 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005863 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005864 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005865 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005866 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02005867 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005868 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005869 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5870 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005871 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005872 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5873 tcp-check expect string +OK
5874
5875 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5876 (send many headers before analyzing)
5877 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005878 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005879 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5880 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5881 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5882 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005883 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005884
5885
5886 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5887
5888
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005889option tcp-smart-accept
5890no option tcp-smart-accept
5891 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5893 yes | yes | yes | no
5894 Arguments : none
5895
5896 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5897 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5898 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5899 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5900 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5901 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5902
5903 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5904 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5905 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5906 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5907
5908 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5909 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5910 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5911 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5912
5913 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5914 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5915 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5916
5917 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5918 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5919 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5920
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005921 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5922
5923
5924option tcp-smart-connect
5925no option tcp-smart-connect
5926 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 yes | no | yes | yes
5929 Arguments : none
5930
5931 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5932 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5933 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5934 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5935 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5936
5937 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5938 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5939 complex.
5940
5941 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5942 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5943 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5944
5945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5947
5948 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5949
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005951option tcpka
5952 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | yes | yes | yes
5955 Arguments : none
5956
5957 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5958 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5959 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5960 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5961
5962 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5963 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5964 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5965 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5966
5967 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5968 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5969 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5970 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5971 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5972
5973 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5974
5975 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5976 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5977 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5978 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5979 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5980 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5981 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5982 backends.
5983
5984 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5985
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005986
5987option tcplog
5988 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 yes | yes | yes | yes
5991 Arguments : none
5992
5993 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5994 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5995 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5996 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5997 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5998 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5999 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6000 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6001
6002 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006004 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006005
6006
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006007option transparent
6008no option transparent
6009 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006012 Arguments : none
6013
6014 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6015 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6016 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6017 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6018 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6019 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6020 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6021 appropriate server.
6022
6023 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6024 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6025
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006026 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006027 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006028
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006030external-check command <command>
6031 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | no | yes | yes
6034
6035 Arguments :
6036 <command> is the external command to run
6037
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006038 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6039
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006040 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006041
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006042 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6043 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6044 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6045 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6046 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6047 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006048
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006049 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6050
6051 Environment variables :
6052 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6053 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6054
6055 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6056
6057 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6058
6059 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6060 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6061 for a UNIX socket).
6062
6063 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6064
6065 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6066
6067 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6068
6069 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6070
6071 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6072
6073 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6074 socket).
6075
6076 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6077 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6078
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006079 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6080 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6081 failed.
6082
6083 Example :
6084 external-check command /bin/true
6085
6086 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6087
6088
6089external-check path <path>
6090 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6092 yes | no | yes | yes
6093
6094 Arguments :
6095 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6096
6097 The default path is "".
6098
6099 Example :
6100 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6101
6102 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6103 "external-check command"
6104
6105
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006106persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006107persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006108 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6110 yes | no | yes | yes
6111 Arguments :
6112 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006113 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6114 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006115
6116 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6117 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6118 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6119 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6120 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6121 forwarded to this server.
6122
6123 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6124 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6125 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006126 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006127 a single "listen" section.
6128
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006129 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6130 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6131 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6132
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006133 Example :
6134 listen tse-farm
6135 bind :3389
6136 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6137 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6138 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6139 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6140 persist rdp-cookie
6141 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006142 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006143 balance rdp-cookie
6144 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6145 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6146
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006147 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6148 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006149
6150
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006151rate-limit sessions <rate>
6152 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6154 yes | yes | yes | no
6155 Arguments :
6156 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6157 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6158
6159 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6160 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6161 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6162 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6163 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6164 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6165
6166 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6167 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6168 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6169 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6170
6171 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6172 listen smtp
6173 mode tcp
6174 bind :25
6175 rate-limit sessions 10
6176 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6177
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006178 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6179 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6180 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006181
6182 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6183
6184
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006185redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6186redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6187redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006188 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6190 no | yes | yes | yes
6191
6192 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006193 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006194
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006195 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006196 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006197 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6198 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6199 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006200
6201 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6202 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6203 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6204 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6205 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006206 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6207 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6208 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6209 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006210
6211 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6212 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6213 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6214 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6215 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6216 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006217 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006218 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006219 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6220 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6221 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006222
6223 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006224 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6225 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6226 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006227 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006228 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6229 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6230 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6231 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006232
6233 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6234 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6235
6236 - "drop-query"
6237 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6238 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6239 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6240 with a location-type redirect.
6241
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006242 - "append-slash"
6243 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6244 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6245 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6246 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6247
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006248 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6249 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6250 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6251 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6252 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6253 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6254 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6255
6256 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6257 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6258 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6259 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6260 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6261 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6262 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006263
6264 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6265 acl clear dst_port 80
6266 acl secure dst_port 8080
6267 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006268 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006269 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006270 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6271
6272 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006273 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6274 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6275 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006276 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006277
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006278 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6279 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6280 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6281
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006282 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006283 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006284
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006285 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6286 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6287 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006289 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006290
6291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006292redisp (deprecated)
6293redispatch (deprecated)
6294 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6296 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006297 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006298
6299 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6300 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6301 be able to access the service anymore.
6302
6303 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6304 redistribute them to a working server.
6305
6306 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6307 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6308 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006310 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6311 "option redispatch" instead.
6312
6313 See also : "option redispatch"
6314
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006315
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006316reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006317 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 no | yes | yes | yes
6320 Arguments :
6321 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6322 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006324
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006325 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6326 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6327
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006328 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6329 the last header of an HTTP request.
6330
6331 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6332 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6333 responses.
6334
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006335 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6336 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6337 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6338
6339 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6340 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006341
6342
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006343reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6344reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006345 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 no | yes | yes | yes
6348 Arguments :
6349 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6350 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6351 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6352 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6353 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6354 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6355 ignores case.
6356
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006357 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6358 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6359
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006360 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6361 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6362 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6363 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006364 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006365
6366 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6367 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6368
6369 Example :
6370 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6371 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6372 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006374 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6375 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006376
6377
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006378reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6379reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006380 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6382 no | yes | yes | yes
6383 Arguments :
6384 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6385 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6386 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6387 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6388 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6389 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006391 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6392 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006394 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6395 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6396 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6397 next servers.
6398
6399 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6400 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6401 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6402
6403 Example :
6404 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6405 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6406 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006408 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6409 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006410
6411
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006412reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6413reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006414 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 no | yes | yes | yes
6417 Arguments :
6418 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6419 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6420 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6421 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6422 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6423 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6424 case.
6425
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006426 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6427 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6428
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006429 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6430 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6431 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6432 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006433 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006434
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006435 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006436 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006437 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006439 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6440 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6441
6442 Example :
6443 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6444 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6445 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006447 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6448 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006449
6450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006451reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6452reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006453 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6455 no | yes | yes | yes
6456 Arguments :
6457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6458 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6459 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6460 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6461 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6462 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6463 case.
6464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006468 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6469 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6470 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6471 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6472
6473 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6474 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6475
6476 Example :
6477 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6478 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6479 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6480 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006482 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6483 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006484
6485
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006486reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6487reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006488 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 no | yes | yes | yes
6491 Arguments :
6492 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6493 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6494 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6495 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6496 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6497 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6498
6499 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6500 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6501 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6502 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006503 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006505 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6506 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6507
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006508 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6509 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6510 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6511
6512 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6513 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6514 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6515 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6516 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6517
6518 Example :
6519 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006520 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006521 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6522 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6523
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006524 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6525 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006526
6527
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006528reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6529reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006530 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6532 no | yes | yes | yes
6533 Arguments :
6534 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6535 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6536 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6537 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6538 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6539 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6540 ignores case.
6541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006542 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6543 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006545 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6546 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006547 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6548 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6549 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006550 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6551 not set.
6552
6553 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6554 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6555 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6556 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6557 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006559 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006560 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6561 # block all others.
6562 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6563 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006565 # block bad guys
6566 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6567 reqitarpit . if badguys
6568
6569 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6570 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006571
6572
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006573retries <value>
6574 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6576 yes | no | yes | yes
6577 Arguments :
6578 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6579 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6580 default value is 3.
6581
6582 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6583 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6584 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6585
6586 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006587 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6588 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006589
6590 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6591 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6592
6593 See also : "option redispatch"
6594
6595
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006596rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006597 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 no | yes | yes | yes
6600 Arguments :
6601 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6602 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006603 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006604
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006605 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6606 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6607
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006608 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6609 the last header of an HTTP response.
6610
6611 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6612 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6613 responses.
6614
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006615 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6616 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006617
6618
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006619rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6620rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006621 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 no | yes | yes | yes
6624 Arguments :
6625 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6626 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6627 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6628 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6629 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6630 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6631 ignores case.
6632
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006633 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6634 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6635
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006636 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6637 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006638 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006639 client.
6640
6641 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6642 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6643 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6644
6645 Example :
6646 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006647 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006648
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006649 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6650 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006651
6652
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006653rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6654rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006655 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 no | yes | yes | yes
6658 Arguments :
6659 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6660 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6661 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6662 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6663 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6664 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6665 ignores case.
6666
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006667 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6668 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6669
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006670 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6671 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6672 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6673 case-sensitive.
6674
6675 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006676 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6677 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6678 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006679
6680 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6681 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6682
6683 Example :
6684 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6685 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6686
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006687 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6688 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006689
6690
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006691rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6692rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006693 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 no | yes | yes | yes
6696 Arguments :
6697 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6698 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6699 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6700 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6701 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6702 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6703 ignores case.
6704
6705 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6706 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6707 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6708 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006709 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006710
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006711 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6712 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6713
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006714 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6715 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6716 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6717
6718 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6719 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6720 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6721 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6722 are not case-sensitive.
6723
6724 Example :
6725 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6726 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6727
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006728 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6729 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006730
6731
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006732server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006733 Declare a server in a backend
6734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 no | no | yes | yes
6736 Arguments :
6737 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006738 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006739 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006740
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006741 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6742 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6743 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6744 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006745 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6746 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6747 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6748 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6749 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006750 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6751 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6752 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6753 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6754 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6755 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6756 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006757 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006758 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6759 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6760 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006762 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006763 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6764 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6765 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6766 adding this value to the client's port.
6767
6768 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6769 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006770 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006771
6772 Examples :
6773 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6774 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006775 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006776 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6777 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6778 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006779
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006780 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6781 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006782
6783
6784source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006785source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006786source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006787 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | no | yes | yes
6790 Arguments :
6791 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6792 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006793
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006794 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006795 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6796 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6797 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6798 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6799 supported prefixes are :
6800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006804 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6805 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006806
6807 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6808 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006809 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6810 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6811 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006812
6813 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6814 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6815 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6816 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6817 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6818 <addr>.
6819
6820 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6821 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6822 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6823 port.
6824
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006825 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6826 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6827 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6828 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006829 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006830 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6831 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6832 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6833 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6834 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6835 HTTP header.
6836
6837 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6838 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006839 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006840 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6841 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6842 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6843 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6844 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6845 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6846 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6847
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006848 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6849 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6850 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6851 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6852 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6853 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6854
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006855 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6856 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6857 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6858 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6859
6860 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6861 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6862 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6863 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6864 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6865 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6866
6867 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6868 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6869 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6870 there are two methods :
6871
6872 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6873 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6874 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6875 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6876 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6877 of the client ranges may be used.
6878
6879 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6880 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6881 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6882 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6883 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6884 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6885 same session.
6886
6887 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6888 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6889 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6890 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6891 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6892 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6893
6894 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6895 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6896 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006897 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006898
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02006899 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
6900
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006901 Examples :
6902 backend private
6903 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6904 source 192.168.1.200
6905
6906 backend transparent_ssl1
6907 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6908 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6909
6910 backend transparent_ssl2
6911 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6912 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6913 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6914
6915 backend transparent_ssl3
6916 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6917 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6918 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6919
6920 backend transparent_smtp
6921 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6922 # with Tproxy version 4.
6923 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6924
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006925 backend transparent_http
6926 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6927 # proxy.
6928 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006930 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006931 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006934srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6935 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | no | yes | yes
6938 Arguments :
6939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6941 as explained at the top of this document.
6942
6943 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6944 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6945 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6946 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6947 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6948 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6949 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6950
6951 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6952 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6953 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6954 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6955 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006956 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006957 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006958 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006959
6960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6962 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6963 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6964 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6965 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6966
6967 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6968 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6969
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006970 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6971 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006972
6973
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006974stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6975 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006977 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006978
6979 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6980 matched.
6981
6982 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6983 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6984
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006985 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6986 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6987 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6988
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006989 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6990 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6991 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6992 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006993
6994 Example :
6995 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6996 backend stats_localhost
6997 stats enable
6998 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6999
7000 Example :
7001 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7002 backend stats_auth
7003 stats enable
7004 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7005 stats admin if TRUE
7006
7007 Example :
7008 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7009 userlist stats-auth
7010 group admin users admin
7011 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7012 group readonly users haproxy
7013 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7014
7015 backend stats_auth
7016 stats enable
7017 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7018 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7019 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7020 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7021
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007022 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7023 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7024 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007025
7026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007027stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7028 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007031 Arguments :
7032 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7033
7034 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7035
7036 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7037 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7038 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7039 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7040 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7041 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7042
7043 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7044 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7045 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007046 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007047
7048 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7049 report using "stats scope".
7050
7051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7053 unobvious parameters.
7054
7055 Example :
7056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7057 backend public_www
7058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7059 stats enable
7060 stats hide-version
7061 stats scope .
7062 stats uri /admin?stats
7063 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7066
7067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7068 backend private_monitoring
7069 stats enable
7070 stats uri /admin?stats
7071 stats refresh 5s
7072
7073 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7074
7075
7076stats enable
7077 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007080 Arguments : none
7081
7082 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7083 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7084 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7085 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7086 - stats auth : no authentication
7087 - stats scope : no restriction
7088
7089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7091 unobvious parameters.
7092
7093 Example :
7094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7095 backend public_www
7096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7097 stats enable
7098 stats hide-version
7099 stats scope .
7100 stats uri /admin?stats
7101 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7104
7105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7106 backend private_monitoring
7107 stats enable
7108 stats uri /admin?stats
7109 stats refresh 5s
7110
7111 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7112
7113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007114stats hide-version
7115 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007118 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007119
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007120 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7121 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7122 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7123 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7124 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7125 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7129 unobvious parameters.
7130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007131 Example :
7132 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7133 backend public_www
7134 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007135 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007136 stats hide-version
7137 stats scope .
7138 stats uri /admin?stats
7139 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7140 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7141 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007142
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7144 backend private_monitoring
7145 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007146 stats uri /admin?stats
7147 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007148
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007149 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007150
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007151
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007152stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7154 Access control for statistics
7155
7156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 no | no | yes | yes
7158
7159 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7160 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7161 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7162 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7163 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7164 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7165
7166 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7167 instance.
7168
7169 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7170 about ACL usage.
7171
7172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007173stats realm <realm>
7174 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007176 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007177 Arguments :
7178 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7179 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7180 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7181
7182 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7183 using a backslash ('\').
7184
7185 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7186 only related to authentication.
7187
7188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7190 unobvious parameters.
7191
7192 Example :
7193 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7194 backend public_www
7195 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7196 stats enable
7197 stats hide-version
7198 stats scope .
7199 stats uri /admin?stats
7200 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7201 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7202 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7203
7204 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7205 backend private_monitoring
7206 stats enable
7207 stats uri /admin?stats
7208 stats refresh 5s
7209
7210 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7211
7212
7213stats refresh <delay>
7214 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007216 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007217 Arguments :
7218 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7219 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7220 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7221 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7222 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7223 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7224
7225 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7226 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7227 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7228 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7229
7230 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7231 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7232 unobvious parameters.
7233
7234 Example :
7235 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7236 backend public_www
7237 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7238 stats enable
7239 stats hide-version
7240 stats scope .
7241 stats uri /admin?stats
7242 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7243 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7244 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7245
7246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7247 backend private_monitoring
7248 stats enable
7249 stats uri /admin?stats
7250 stats refresh 5s
7251
7252 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7253
7254
7255stats scope { <name> | "." }
7256 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007259 Arguments :
7260 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7261 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7262 section in which the statement appears.
7263
7264 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7265 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7266 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7267 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7268 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7269 exists.
7270
7271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7273 unobvious parameters.
7274
7275 Example :
7276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7277 backend public_www
7278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7279 stats enable
7280 stats hide-version
7281 stats scope .
7282 stats uri /admin?stats
7283 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7286
7287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7288 backend private_monitoring
7289 stats enable
7290 stats uri /admin?stats
7291 stats refresh 5s
7292
7293 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007296stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007297 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007300
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007301 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007302 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7303
7304 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7305 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7306
7307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007309 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007310
7311 Example :
7312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7313 backend private_monitoring
7314 stats enable
7315 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7316 stats uri /admin?stats
7317 stats refresh 5s
7318
7319 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7320 global section.
7321
7322
7323stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007324 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | yes | yes | yes
7327 Arguments : none
7328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007329 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007330 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7331 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7332 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7333 - IP (socket, server)
7334 - cookie (backend, server)
7335
7336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007338 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007339
7340 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7341
7342
7343stats show-node [ <name> ]
7344 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007347 Arguments:
7348 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7349 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7350
7351 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7352 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007353 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007354
7355 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7356 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7357 unobvious parameters.
7358
7359 Example:
7360 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7361 backend private_monitoring
7362 stats enable
7363 stats show-node Europe-1
7364 stats uri /admin?stats
7365 stats refresh 5s
7366
7367 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7368 section.
7369
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007370
7371stats uri <prefix>
7372 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007374 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007375 Arguments :
7376 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7377 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7378 query string.
7379
7380 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7381 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7382 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7383 possible to reach it in the application.
7384
7385 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007386 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007387 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7388 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7389 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7390 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7391
7392 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7393 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7394 an address or a port to statistics only.
7395
7396 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7397 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7398 unobvious parameters.
7399
7400 Example :
7401 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7402 backend public_www
7403 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7404 stats enable
7405 stats hide-version
7406 stats scope .
7407 stats uri /admin?stats
7408 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7409 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7410 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7411
7412 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7413 backend private_monitoring
7414 stats enable
7415 stats uri /admin?stats
7416 stats refresh 5s
7417
7418 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7419
7420
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007421stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7422 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007424 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007425
7426 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007427 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007428 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7429 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7430 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7431
7432 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7433 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7434 the "stick-table" statement.
7435
7436 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7437 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7438 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7439 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7440 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7441
7442 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7443 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7444 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7445 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7446 transformation rules.
7447
7448 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7449 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7450 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7451 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7452 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7453 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7454 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7455
7456 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7457 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7458 ACL based conditions.
7459
7460 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7461 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7462 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7463 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7464
7465 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7466 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7467 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7468 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7469
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007470 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7471 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7472 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7473
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007474 Example :
7475 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7476 # last 30 minutes
7477 backend pop
7478 mode tcp
7479 balance roundrobin
7480 stick store-request src
7481 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7482 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7483 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7484
7485 backend smtp
7486 mode tcp
7487 balance roundrobin
7488 stick match src table pop
7489 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7490 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7491
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007492 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007493 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007494
7495
7496stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7497 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 no | no | yes | yes
7500
7501 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7502 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7503 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7504 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7505
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007506 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7507 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7508 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007510 Examples :
7511 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007512 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007513
7514 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7515 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7516 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7517
7518
7519 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7520 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7521 backend http
7522 mode http
7523 balance roundrobin
7524 stick on src table https
7525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7526 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7527 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7528
7529 backend https
7530 mode tcp
7531 balance roundrobin
7532 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7533 stick on src
7534 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7535 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007537 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007538
7539
7540stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7541 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 no | no | yes | yes
7544
7545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007546 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007547 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7548 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7549 server is selected.
7550
7551 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7552 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7553 the "stick-table" statement.
7554
7555 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7556 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7557 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7558 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7559 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7560 address.
7561
7562 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7563 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7564 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7565 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7566 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7567 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7568 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7569 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7570 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7571 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7572
7573 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7574 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7575 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7576 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7577 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7578 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7579 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7580
7581 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7582 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7583 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7584 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7585
7586 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7587 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7588 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7589 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7590 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7591 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007592 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7593 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7594 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7595 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7596 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7597 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007598
7599 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7600 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7601 the request.
7602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007603 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7604 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7605 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7606
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007607 Example :
7608 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7609 # last 30 minutes
7610 backend pop
7611 mode tcp
7612 balance roundrobin
7613 stick store-request src
7614 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7615 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7616 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7617
7618 backend smtp
7619 mode tcp
7620 balance roundrobin
7621 stick match src table pop
7622 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7623 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7624
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007625 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007626 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007627
7628
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007629stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007630 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7631 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007632 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007634 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007635
7636 Arguments :
7637 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7638 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7639 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7640 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7641
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007642 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7643 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7644 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7645 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7646
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007647 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7648 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7649 instance.
7650
7651 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7652 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7653 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7654 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7655 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7656 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007657 to 32 characters.
7658
7659 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7660 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7661 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007662 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007663 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7664 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007665
7666 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007667 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7668 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007669 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7670 increase.
7671
7672 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007673 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7674 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7675 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007676
7677 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7678 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7679 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7680 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7681 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7682 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7683 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7684 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7685 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7686 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7687 parameter (see below).
7688
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007689 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7690 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7691 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7692 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7693 soft restart.
7694
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007695 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7696 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007697
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007698 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7699 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7700 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7701 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7702 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007703 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007704 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7705 if not expiration delay is specified.
7706
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007707 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7708 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7709 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7710 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007711 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7712 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7713 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7714 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7715 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7716 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7717 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7718 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7719 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7720 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7721 types and their arguments.
7722
7723 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7724 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7725 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7726 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7727
7728 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7729 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7730 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7731 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7732
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007733 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7734 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7735 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7736 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7737 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7738 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7739
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007740 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7741 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7742 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7743 they were received.
7744
7745 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7746 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7747 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7748 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7749 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7750
7751 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7752 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7753 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7754 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7755 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7756
7757 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7758 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7759 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7760
7761 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7762 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7763 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7764 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7765 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7766
7767 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7768 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7769 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7770 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7771 the client side.
7772
7773 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7774 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7775 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7776 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7777 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7778 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7779 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7780
7781 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7782 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7783 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7784 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7785 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7786 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7787 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7788
7789 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7790 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7791 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7792 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7793 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7794 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7795
7796 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7797 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7798 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7799 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7800
7801 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7802 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7803 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7804 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7805 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7806 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7807 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7808 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7809 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7810 recommended for better fairness.
7811
7812 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7813 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7814 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7815 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7816
7817 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7818 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7819 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7820 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7821 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7822 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7823 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7824 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7825 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7826 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007827
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007828 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7829 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007830 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7831 reference it.
7832
7833 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7834 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7835 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7836 as an exclusive stickiness.
7837
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007838 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7839 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7840 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7841 something that can be ignored.
7842
7843 Example:
7844 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7845 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7846 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7847 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7848
7849 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007850 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007851
7852
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007853stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7854 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 no | no | yes | yes
7857
7858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007859 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007860 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7861 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7862 server is selected.
7863
7864 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7865 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7866 the "stick-table" statement.
7867
7868 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7869 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7870 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7871 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7872
7873 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7874 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7875 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7876 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7877 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7878 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007879 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007880 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7881 rules.
7882
7883 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7884 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7885 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7886 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7887 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7888 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7889 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7890
7891 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7892 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7893 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7894 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7895
7896 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7897 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7898 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7899 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7900 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7901 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007902 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7903 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7904 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7905 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7906 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7907 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7908 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7909 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7910 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007911
7912 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7913
7914 Example :
7915 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7916 backend https
7917 mode tcp
7918 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007919 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007920 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007921
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007922 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7923 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7924
7925 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7926 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7927 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7928
7929 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7930 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007931
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007932 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7933 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7934 # at offset 44.
7935
7936 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7937 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7938
7939 # Learn on response if server hello.
7940 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007941
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007942 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7943 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7944
7945 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7946 extraction.
7947
7948
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007949tcp-check connect [params*]
7950 Opens a new connection
7951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7952 no | no | yes | yes
7953
7954 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7955 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7956 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7957
7958 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7959 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7960 of the sequence.
7961
7962 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7963 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7964 do.
7965
7966 Parameters :
7967 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7968 use the TCP connection.
7969
7970 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7971 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7972 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7973
7974 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7975
7976 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7977
7978 Examples:
7979 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7980 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7981 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7982 option tcp-check
7983 tcp-check connect
7984 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7985 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7986 tcp-check send \r\n
7987 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7988 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7989 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7990 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7991 tcp-check send \r\n
7992 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7993 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7994
7995 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7996 option tcp-check
7997 tcp-check connect port 110
7998 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7999 tcp-check connect port 143
8000 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8001 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8002
8003 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8004
8005
8006tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8007 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8009 no | no | yes | yes
8010
8011 Arguments :
8012 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8013 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8014 binary.
8015 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8016 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8017 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8018
8019 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8020 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8021 with the usual backslash ('\').
8022 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8023 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8024 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8025 used upper or lower case.
8026
8027
8028 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8029
8030 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8032 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8033 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8034 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8035 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8036 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8037 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8038
8039 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8040 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8041 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8042 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8043 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8044 expression.
8045
8046 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8047 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8048 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8049 this exact hexadecimal string.
8050 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8051
8052 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8053 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8054 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8055 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8056 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8057 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8058 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8059 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8060 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8061 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8062 the null character.
8063
8064 Examples :
8065 # perform a POP check
8066 option tcp-check
8067 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8068
8069 # perform an IMAP check
8070 option tcp-check
8071 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8072
8073 # look for the redis master server
8074 option tcp-check
8075 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008076 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008077 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8078 tcp-check expect string role:master
8079 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8080 tcp-check expect string +OK
8081
8082
8083 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8084 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8085
8086
8087tcp-check send <data>
8088 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 no | no | yes | yes
8091
8092 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8093 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8094
8095 Examples :
8096 # look for the redis master server
8097 option tcp-check
8098 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8099 tcp-check expect string role:master
8100
8101 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8102 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8103
8104
8105tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8106 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8107 tcp health check
8108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 no | no | yes | yes
8110
8111 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8112 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8113 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8114 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8115 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8116 hexadecimal string.
8117 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8118
8119 Examples :
8120 # redis check in binary
8121 option tcp-check
8122 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8123 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8124
8125
8126 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8127 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8128
8129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008130tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8131 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008134 Arguments :
8135 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008136 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8137 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008139 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008140
8141 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8142 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008143 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8144 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8145 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8146 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8147 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8148 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008150 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8151 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8152 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8153 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008154
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008155 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008156 - accept :
8157 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8158 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8159 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008161 - reject :
8162 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8163 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8164 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8165 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8166 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8167 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8168 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8169 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8170 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8171 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8172 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8173 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008174
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008175 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8176 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8177 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8178 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8179 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8180 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8181 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8182 hosts.
8183
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008184 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8185 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8186 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8187 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8188 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8189 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8190 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8191 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8192 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008193 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8194 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008195
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008196 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008197 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008198 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008199 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008200 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8201 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008202 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008203 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8204 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8205 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8206 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8207 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008209 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008210 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008211 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008212 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8213 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8214 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8215 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008217 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8218 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8219 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8220 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8223 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8224 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8225 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8226 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008227 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8228 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8229 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8230 layer7 information is extracted.
8231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8233 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8234 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8235 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8236 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008238 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8239 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8240 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008242 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8243 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8244 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008246 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008247 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008248 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008250 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8251 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8252 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008254 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008255 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8256 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008257
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008258 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8259
8260 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8261
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008262 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008264 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008265
8266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008267tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8268 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008270 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008271 Arguments :
8272 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008273 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008274 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8275 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008277 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008279 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8280 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8281 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8282 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8283 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008285 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8286 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8287 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8288 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008289 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8290 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8291 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8292 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8293 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8294 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008295 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008296 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008298 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8299 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8300 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8301 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008302
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008303 Four types of actions are supported :
8304 - accept : the request is accepted
8305 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8306 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008307 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008308 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008309 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008311 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8312 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008313
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008314 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8315 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8316 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8317 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8318 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8319 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008321 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008322 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8323 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008325 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008326 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8327 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8328 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8329 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008330 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8331 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8332 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008333
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008334 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008335 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8336 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8337 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008338
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008339 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8340 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8341 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8342 documentation.
8343
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008344 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8345 declared inline.
8346
8347 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8348 The allowed scopes are:
8349 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8350 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8351 (request and response)
8352 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8353 processing
8354 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8355 processing.
8356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8357 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8358
8359 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8360 followed by some converters.
8361
8362 Example:
8363
8364 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8365
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008366 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008367 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8368 # and reject everything else.
8369 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8370 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008371 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008372 tcp-request content reject
8373
8374 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008375 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8376 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8377 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008378 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008379
8380 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8381 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8382 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008383 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008384 tcp-request content reject
8385
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008386 Example:
8387 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8388 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008389 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008390
8391 Example:
8392 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8393 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008394 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008396 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8397 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8398
8399 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008400 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008401 # protecting all our sites
8402 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008403 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8404 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008405 ...
8406 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8407
8408 backend http_dynamic
8409 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008410 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008411 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008412 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8413 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8414 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008415 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008417 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008419 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008420
8421
8422tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8423 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008425 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008426 Arguments :
8427 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8429 as explained at the top of this document.
8430
8431 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8432 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8433 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8434 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8435 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8436
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008437 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8438 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8439 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8440 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008442 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8443 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008444 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008445 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008446 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8447 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8448 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8449 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008450
8451 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8452 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8453 it pass through unaffected.
8454
8455 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8456 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8457 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008458 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008459 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8460 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008461 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8462 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8463 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008464
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008465 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008466 "timeout client".
8467
8468
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008469tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8470 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 no | no | yes | yes
8473 Arguments :
8474 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008475 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008476
8477 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8478
8479 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8480 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8481 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008482 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8483 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008484
8485 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8486
8487 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8488 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8489 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8490 inserted.
8491
8492 Two types of actions are supported :
8493 - accept :
8494 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8495 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8496 the rules evaluation.
8497
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008498 - close :
8499 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8500 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8501 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8502 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8503 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8504 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008505 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008506 protocols.
8507
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008508 - reject :
8509 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8510 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008511 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008512
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008513 - lua <function>
8514 Executes Lua.
8515
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008516 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8517 Sets a variable.
8518
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008519 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8520 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8521 for changing the default action to a reject.
8522
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008523 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8524 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8525 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8526 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008527 period.
8528
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008529 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8530 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8531 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8532 documentation.
8533
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008534 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8535 declared inline.
8536
8537 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8538 The allowed scopes are:
8539 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8540 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8541 (request and response)
8542 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8543 processing
8544 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8545 processing.
8546 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8547 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8548
8549 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8550 followed by some converters.
8551
8552 Example:
8553
8554 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008556 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8557
8558 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8559
8560
8561tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8562 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8564 no | no | yes | yes
8565 Arguments :
8566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8568 as explained at the top of this document.
8569
8570 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8571
8572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008573timeout check <timeout>
8574 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8575 established.
8576
8577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8578 yes | no | yes | yes
8579 Arguments:
8580 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8581 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8582 as explained at the top of this document.
8583
8584 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8585 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8586 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8587 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008588 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8589 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8590 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008591
8592 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8593 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8594
8595 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8596 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008597 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008598
8599 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8600 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8601 forget about it.
8602
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008603 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8604 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008605
8606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008607timeout client <timeout>
8608timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8609 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8611 yes | yes | yes | no
8612 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008613 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008614 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8615 as explained at the top of this document.
8616
8617 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8618 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8619 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8620 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8621 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8622 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8623 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8624 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008625 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008626 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008627 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8628 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008629 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8630 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008631
8632 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8633 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8634 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8635 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8636 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8637 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8638
8639 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8640 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8641 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8642
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008643 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008644
8645
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008646timeout client-fin <timeout>
8647 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 yes | yes | yes | no
8650 Arguments :
8651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8653 as explained at the top of this document.
8654
8655 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8656 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8657 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8658 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8659 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8660 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8661 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8662 down in one direction.
8663
8664 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8665 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8666 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8667
8668 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8669
8670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008671timeout connect <timeout>
8672timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8673 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8675 yes | no | yes | yes
8676 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008677 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008678 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8679 as explained at the top of this document.
8680
8681 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008682 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008683 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008684 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008685 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8686 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008687
8688 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8689 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8690 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8691 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8692 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8693 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8694
8695 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8696 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8697 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8698
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008699 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8700 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008701
8702
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008703timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8704 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8706 yes | yes | yes | yes
8707 Arguments :
8708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8710 as explained at the top of this document.
8711
8712 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8713 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8714 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8715 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8716 once the request has started to present itself.
8717
8718 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8719 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8720 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8721 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8722 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8723
8724 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8725 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8726 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8727 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8728
8729 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8730 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8731 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8732 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8733 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008734 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008735
8736 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8737 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8738 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8739 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8740
8741 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8742
8743
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008744timeout http-request <timeout>
8745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008747 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008748 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8751 as explained at the top of this document.
8752
8753 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8754 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8755 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8756 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8757 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8758 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8759 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008760 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8761 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8762 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8763 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8764 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008765 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8766 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008767
8768 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8769 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008770 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8771 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008772
8773 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8774 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8775 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8776 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8777 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8778
8779 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008780 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8781 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8782 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008783
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008784 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8785 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008786
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008787
8788timeout queue <timeout>
8789 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8791 yes | no | yes | yes
8792 Arguments :
8793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8795 as explained at the top of this document.
8796
8797 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8798 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8799 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8800 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8801 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8802
8803 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8804 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8805 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8806 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8807
8808 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8809
8810
8811timeout server <timeout>
8812timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8813 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8815 yes | no | yes | yes
8816 Arguments :
8817 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8818 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8819 as explained at the top of this document.
8820
8821 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8822 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8823 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8824 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8825 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8826 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8827 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8828
8829 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8830 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8831 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8832 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8833 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008834 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008835 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008836 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8837 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8838 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8839 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008840
8841 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8842 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8843 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8844 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8845 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8846 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8847
8848 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8849 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8850 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8851
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008852 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008853
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008854
8855timeout server-fin <timeout>
8856 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8858 yes | no | yes | yes
8859 Arguments :
8860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8862 as explained at the top of this document.
8863
8864 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8865 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8866 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8867 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8868 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8869 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8870 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8871 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8872 situations, it should not be needed.
8873
8874 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8875 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8876 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8877
8878 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8879
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008880
8881timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008882 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8884 yes | yes | yes | yes
8885 Arguments :
8886 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8888 as explained at the top of this document.
8889
8890 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8891 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8892 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8893
8894 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8895 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8896 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8897 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008898 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008899
8900 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8901
8902
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008903timeout tunnel <timeout>
8904 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8906 yes | no | yes | yes
8907 Arguments :
8908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8910 as explained at the top of this document.
8911
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008912 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008913 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8914 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8915 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8916 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8917 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8918 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8919 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8920 specified.
8921
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008922 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8923 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8924 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8925 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8926 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8927 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8928 state.
8929
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008930 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8931 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8932 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8933 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8934 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8935
8936 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8937 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8938 forget about it.
8939
8940 Example :
8941 defaults http
8942 option http-server-close
8943 timeout connect 5s
8944 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008945 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008946 timeout server 30s
8947 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8948
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008949 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008950
8951
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008952transparent (deprecated)
8953 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008956 Arguments : none
8957
8958 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8959 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8960 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8961 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8962 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8963 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8964 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8965 appropriate server.
8966
8967 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8968
8969 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8970 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8971
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008972 See also: "option transparent"
8973
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008974unique-id-format <string>
8975 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8977 yes | yes | yes | no
8978 Arguments :
8979 <string> is a log-format string.
8980
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008981 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8982 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8983 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8984 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008985
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008986 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8987 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8988 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8989 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8990 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8991 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8992 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8993 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008994
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008995 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8996 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008997
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008998 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008999
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009000 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009001
9002 will generate:
9003
9004 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9005
9006 See also: "unique-id-header"
9007
9008unique-id-header <name>
9009 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9011 yes | yes | yes | no
9012 Arguments :
9013 <name> is the name of the header.
9014
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009015 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9016 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009017
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009018 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009019
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009020 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009021 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9022
9023 will generate:
9024
9025 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9026
9027 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009028
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009029use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009030 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 no | yes | yes | no
9033 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009034 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9035 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009036
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009037 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9038 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009039
9040 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9041 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9042 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009043 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9044 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9045 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9046 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009047
9048 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9049 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9050 assign the backend.
9051
9052 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9053 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9054 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9055 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9056 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9057 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9058
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009059 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009060 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009061 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9062 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9063 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9064
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009065 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9066 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9067 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9068 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9069 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9070 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9071 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9072 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9073 cannot be forced from the request.
9074
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009075 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009076 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9077 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9078
9079 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9080 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009081
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009082
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009083use-server <server> if <condition>
9084use-server <server> unless <condition>
9085 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9087 no | no | yes | yes
9088 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009089 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009090
9091 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9092
9093 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9094 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9095 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9096
9097 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9098 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9099 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9100 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9101 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9102 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9103 matches will assign the server.
9104
9105 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9106 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9107 with the next rules until one matches.
9108
9109 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9110 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9111 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9112 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9113
9114 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9115 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9116 stripped.
9117
9118 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9119 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9120 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9121 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9122
9123 Example :
9124 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9125 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9126 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9127 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9128 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9129 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9130 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9131 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9132 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9133
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009134 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009136
91375. Bind and Server options
9138--------------------------
9139
9140The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9141depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9142settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9143written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9144described in this section.
9145
9146
91475.1. Bind options
9148-----------------
9149
9150The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9151as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9152no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9153parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9154while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9155provided immediately after the setting name.
9156
9157The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9158
9159accept-proxy
9160 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009161 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9162 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009163 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9164 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9165 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9166 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9167 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9168 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9169 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009170 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9171 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009172
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009173alpn <protocols>
9174 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9175 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9176 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9177 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9178 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9179 initial NPN extension.
9180
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009181backlog <backlog>
9182 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9183 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9184
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009185ecdhe <named curve>
9186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009187 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9188 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009189
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009190ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9192 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9193 client's certificate.
9194
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009195ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9197 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9198 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9199 error is ignored.
9200
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009201ca-sign-file <cafile>
9202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9203 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9204 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9205 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9206 'generate-certificates' for details.
9207
9208ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9210 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9211 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9212 'generate-certificates' for details.
9213
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009214ciphers <ciphers>
9215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9216 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009217 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009218 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9219 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9220
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009221crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9223 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9224 to verify client's certificate.
9225
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009226crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9228 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9229 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9230 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9231 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9232 file.
9233
9234 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9235 are loaded.
9236
9237 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009238 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009239 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9240 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9241 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9242 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9243 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9244 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9245 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009246
9247 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9248 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9249 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9250 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009251 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9252 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009253
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009254 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009255
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009256 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9257 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009258 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009259 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9260 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9261 clients).
9262
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009263 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9264 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9265 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9266 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9267 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9268 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9269 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9270 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9271 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9272 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9273 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9274 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9275 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9276
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009277 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9278 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9279 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9280 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9281 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9282
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009283crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9285 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009286 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009287 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009288
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009289crt-list <file>
9290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009291 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9292 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009293
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009294 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009295
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009296 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9297 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9298 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9299 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9300 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9301 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9302 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9303 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009304
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009305defer-accept
9306 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9307 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9308 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9309 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9310 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9311 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9312 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9313 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9314 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9315 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9316 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9317
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009318force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009319 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009320 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009321 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9322 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009323
9324force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009325 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009326 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9327 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009328
9329force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009331 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9332 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009333
9334force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009335 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009336 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9337 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009338
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009339generate-certificates
9340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9341 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9342 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9343 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9344 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9345 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9346 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9347 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9348 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9349 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9350 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9351
9352 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9353 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9354 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9355 certificate is used many times.
9356
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009357gid <gid>
9358 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9359 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9360 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9361 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9362 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9363
9364group <group>
9365 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9366 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9367 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9368 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9369 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9370
9371id <id>
9372 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9373 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9374 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9375 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9376
9377interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009378 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9379 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9380 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9381 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9382 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9383 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9384 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009385
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009386level <level>
9387 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9388 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9389 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9390 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9391 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9392 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9393 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9394 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9395 counters).
9396 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9397 all counters).
9398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009399maxconn <maxconn>
9400 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9401 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9402 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9403 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9404 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9405 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9406 eat all memory.
9407
9408mode <mode>
9409 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9410 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9411 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9412 UNIX sockets.
9413
9414mss <maxseg>
9415 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9416 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9417 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9418 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9419 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9420 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9421 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9422 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9423 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9424 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9425 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9426
9427name <name>
9428 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9429 page.
9430
9431nice <nice>
9432 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9433 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9434 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9435 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9436 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9437 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9438 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9439 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9440 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9441 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9442 one for an RDP socket.
9443
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009444no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009446 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009447 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009448 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9449 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009450 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009451
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009452no-tls-tickets
9453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9454 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9455 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009456 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9457 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009458
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009459no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009461 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009462 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009463 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9464 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9465 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009466
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009467no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009469 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009470 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009471 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9472 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9473 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009474
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009475no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009477 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009478 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009479 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9480 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9481 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009482
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009483npn <protocols>
9484 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9485 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9486 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9487 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009488 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9489 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009490
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009491process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9492 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9493 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9494 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9495 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9496 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9497 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9498 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009499 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9500 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9501 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9502 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9503 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9504 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9505 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009506
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009507ssl
9508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009509 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009510 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9511 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9512 to deciphered contents.
9513
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009514strict-sni
9515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9516 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9517 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9518 See the "crt" option for more information.
9519
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009520tcp-ut <delay>
9521 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9522 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9523 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9524 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9525 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9526 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9527 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9528 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9529 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9530 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9531 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9532
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009533tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009534 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009535 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9536 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9537 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9538 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9539 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9540 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9541 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009542 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9543 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9544 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009545
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009546tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9547 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9548 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9549 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9550 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9551 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9552 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9553 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9554 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9555 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9556 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9557
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009558transparent
9559 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9560 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9561 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9562 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9563 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9564 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9565 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9566 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9567 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9568 so check for support with your vendor.
9569
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009570v4v6
9571 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9572 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9573 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9574 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009575 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009576
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009577v6only
9578 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9579 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9580 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009581 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9582 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009583
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009584uid <uid>
9585 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9586 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9587 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9588 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9589 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9590
9591user <user>
9592 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9593 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9594 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9595 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9596 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9597
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009598verify [none|optional|required]
9599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9600 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9601 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9602 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9603 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009604 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9605 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9606 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9607 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009608
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020096095.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009610------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009612The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9613which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9614arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9615settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9616after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9617Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9618address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009620 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009621 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009623The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009624
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009625addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009626 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9627 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9628 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9629 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9630 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009632 Supported in default-server: No
9633
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009634agent-check
9635 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009636 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9637 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9638 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9639 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009640
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009641 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009642 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009643 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9644 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9645 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009646
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009647 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9648 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009649
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009650 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9651 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9652 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009653
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009654 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9655 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9656 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009657
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009658 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9659 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9660 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9661 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9662 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9663 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9664 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009665
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009666 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9667 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009668
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009669 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9670 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9671 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9672 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9673 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9674 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9675 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9676 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9677 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009678
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009679 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9680 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009681 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9682 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9683 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9684 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009685
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009686 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9687 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009688
9689 Supported in default-server: No
9690
9691agent-inter <delay>
9692 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9693 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9694
9695 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9696 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9697 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9698 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9699 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9700 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9701 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9702 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9703 of backends use the same servers.
9704
9705 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9706
9707 Supported in default-server: Yes
9708
9709agent-port <port>
9710 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9711
9712 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9713
9714 Supported in default-server: Yes
9715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009716backup
9717 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9718 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9719 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9720 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9721 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9722 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009724 Supported in default-server: No
9725
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009726ca-file <cafile>
9727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9728 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9729 server's certificate.
9730
9731 Supported in default-server: No
9732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733check
9734 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009735 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9736 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9737 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9738 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9739 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9740 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9741 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009742 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9743 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9744 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009746 Supported in default-server: No
9747
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009748check-send-proxy
9749 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9750 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9751 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9752 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9753 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9754 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9755 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9756
9757 Supported in default-server: No
9758
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009759check-ssl
9760 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9761 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9762 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9763 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009764 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009765 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9766 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9767 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9768 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9769
9770 Supported in default-server: No
9771
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009772ciphers <ciphers>
9773 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009774 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009775 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9776 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9777 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9778 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9779 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9780 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9781
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009782 Supported in default-server: No
9783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009784cookie <value>
9785 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9786 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9787 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9788 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9789 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9790 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9791 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009793 Supported in default-server: No
9794
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009795crl-file <crlfile>
9796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9797 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9798 to verify server's certificate.
9799
9800 Supported in default-server: No
9801
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009802crt <cert>
9803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9804 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9805 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9806 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9807 certificate request.
9808
9809 Supported in default-server: No
9810
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009811disabled
9812 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9813 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9814 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9815 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9816 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9817
9818 Supported in default-server: No
9819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009820error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009821 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9822 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9823 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009825 Supported in default-server: Yes
9826
9827 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009829fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009830 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9831 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9832 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009834 Supported in default-server: Yes
9835
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009836force-sslv3
9837 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9838 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009839 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9840 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009841
9842 Supported in default-server: No
9843
9844force-tlsv10
9845 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009846 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9847 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009848
9849 Supported in default-server: No
9850
9851force-tlsv11
9852 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009853 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9854 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009855
9856 Supported in default-server: No
9857
9858force-tlsv12
9859 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009860 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9861 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009862
9863 Supported in default-server: No
9864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009865id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009866 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9867 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9868 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009870 Supported in default-server: No
9871
9872inter <delay>
9873fastinter <delay>
9874downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009875 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9876 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9877 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9878 between checks depending on the server state :
9879
9880 Server state | Interval used
9881 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9882 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9883 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9884 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9885 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9886 or yet unchecked. |
9887 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9888 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9889 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009891 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9892 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9893 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9894 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009895 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9896 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9897 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9898 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9899 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009901 Supported in default-server: Yes
9902
9903maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009904 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9905 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9906 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9907 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9908 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9909 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9910 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9911 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009913 Supported in default-server: Yes
9914
9915maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009916 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9917 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9918 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9919 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9920 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9921 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9922 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009924 Supported in default-server: Yes
9925
9926minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009927 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9928 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9929 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9930 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9931 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9932 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009933 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009934 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009936 Supported in default-server: Yes
9937
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009938no-ssl-reuse
9939 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9940 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9941 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9942 and for paranoid users.
9943
9944 Supported in default-server: No
9945
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009946no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009947 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9948 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009949 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009950
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009951 Supported in default-server: No
9952
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009953no-tls-tickets
9954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9955 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9956 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009957 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9958 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009959
9960 Supported in default-server: No
9961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009962no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009963 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009964 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9965 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009966 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9967 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9968 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009969
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009970 Supported in default-server: No
9971
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009972no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009973 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009974 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9975 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009976 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9977 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9978 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009979
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009980 Supported in default-server: No
9981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009982no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009983 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009984 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9985 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009986 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9987 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9988 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009989
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009990 Supported in default-server: No
9991
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009992non-stick
9993 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9994 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9995 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9996
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009997 Supported in default-server: No
9998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009999observe <mode>
10000 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10001 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10002 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10003 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10004 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10005 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010006 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010008 Supported in default-server: No
10009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010010 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010012on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010013 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10014 Currently, four modes are available:
10015 - fastinter: force fastinter
10016 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10017 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10018 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10019 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010021 Supported in default-server: Yes
10022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010023 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10024
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010025on-marked-down <action>
10026 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10027 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010028 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10029 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10030 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10031 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10032 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10033 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10034 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10035 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010036
10037 Actions are disabled by default
10038
10039 Supported in default-server: Yes
10040
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010041on-marked-up <action>
10042 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10043 Currently one action is available:
10044 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10045 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10046 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10047 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10048 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10049 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10050 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10051 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10052
10053 Actions are disabled by default
10054
10055 Supported in default-server: Yes
10056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010057port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010058 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10059 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10060 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10061 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10062 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10063 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010065 Supported in default-server: Yes
10066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010067redir <prefix>
10068 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10069 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10070 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10071 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10072 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10073 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10074 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10075 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010076 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010077 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10078 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10079 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10080 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10081 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10082
10083 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010085 Supported in default-server: No
10086
10087rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010088 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10089 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10090 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010092 Supported in default-server: Yes
10093
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010094resolve-prefer <family>
10095 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10096 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10097 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10098 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10099
10100 Default value: ipv4
10101
10102 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10103
10104resolvers <id>
10105 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10106 hostname.
10107
10108 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10109
10110 See also chapter 5.3
10111
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010112send-proxy
10113 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10114 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10115 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10116 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10117 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10118 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10119 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10120 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10121 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010122 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10123 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10124 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10125 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10126 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010127
10128 Supported in default-server: No
10129
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010130send-proxy-v2
10131 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10132 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10133 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10134 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10135 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10136 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10137 option of the "bind" keyword.
10138
10139 Supported in default-server: No
10140
10141send-proxy-v2-ssl
10142 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10143 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10144 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10145 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10146 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10147 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10148 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10149 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10150
10151 Supported in default-server: No
10152
10153send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10154 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10155 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10156 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10157 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10158 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10159 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10160 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10161 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10162 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10163
10164 Supported in default-server: No
10165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010166slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010167 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10168 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10169 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10170 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10171 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10172 parameters :
10173
10174 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10175 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10176
10177 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10178 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10179 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10180 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10181
10182 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10183 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10184 seen as failed.
10185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010186 Supported in default-server: Yes
10187
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010188sni <expression>
10189 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10190 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10191 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10192 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10193 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10194
10195 Supported in default-server: no
10196
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010197source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010198source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010199source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010200 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10201 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10202 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10203 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10204
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010205 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10206 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10207 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10208 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10209 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10210 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10211 server.
10212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010213 Supported in default-server: No
10214
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010215ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010216 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10217 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10218 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10219 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10220 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10221 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010222 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010223
10224 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010226track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010227 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10228 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10229 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10230 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010231 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010233 Supported in default-server: No
10234
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010235verify [none|required]
10236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010237 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10238 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10239 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10240 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010241 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10242 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10243 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010244
10245 Supported in default-server: No
10246
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010247verifyhost <hostname>
10248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10249 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10250 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10251 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10252 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10253 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10254
10255 Supported in default-server: No
10256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010257weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010258 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10259 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10260 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010261 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10262 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10263 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10264 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10265 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10266 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010268 Supported in default-server: Yes
10269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010270
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200102715.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10272-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010273
10274HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10275IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10276configuration, at startup.
10277This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10278can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10279workload.
10280This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10281resolution at run time.
10282Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10283carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10284
10285
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200102865.3.1. Global overview
10287----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010288
10289As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10290different steps of the process life:
10291
10292 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10293 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10294 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10295
10296 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10297 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10298 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10299
10300A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10301 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10302 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10303 resolution to know this new IP.
10304
10305A few things important to notice:
10306 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10307 first valid response.
10308
10309 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10310 servers return an error.
10311
10312
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103135.3.2. The resolvers section
10314----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010315
10316This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10317HAProxy.
10318There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10319many name servers.
10320
10321resolvers <resolvers id>
10322 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10323
10324A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10325
10326nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10327 DNS server description:
10328 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10329 <ip> : IP address of the server
10330 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10331
10332hold <status> <period>
10333 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10334 on last resolution <status>
10335 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10336 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10337 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10338 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10339
10340 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10341
10342 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10343 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10344 the healch check.
10345
10346resolve_retries <nb>
10347 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10348 giving up.
10349 Default value: 3
10350
10351timeout <event> <time>
10352 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10353 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10354 events available are:
10355 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10356 been received.
10357 Default value: 1s
10358 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10359 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10360
10361Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10362
10363 resolvers mydns
10364 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10365 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10366 resolve_retries 3
10367 timeout retry 1s
10368 hold valid 10s
10369
10370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103716. HTTP header manipulation
10372---------------------------
10373
10374In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10375response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10376request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10377which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010378against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010379
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010380If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10381to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10382but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10383HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10384stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10385because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10386a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10387still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010389This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10390in section 4.2 :
10391
10392 - reqadd <string>
10393 - reqallow <search>
10394 - reqiallow <search>
10395 - reqdel <search>
10396 - reqidel <search>
10397 - reqdeny <search>
10398 - reqideny <search>
10399 - reqpass <search>
10400 - reqipass <search>
10401 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10402 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10403 - reqtarpit <search>
10404 - reqitarpit <search>
10405 - rspadd <string>
10406 - rspdel <search>
10407 - rspidel <search>
10408 - rspdeny <search>
10409 - rspideny <search>
10410 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10411 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10412
10413With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10414is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10415parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10416prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10417Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10418
10419 \t for a tab
10420 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10421 \n for a new line (LF)
10422 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10423 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10424 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10425 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10426 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10427
10428The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10429portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10430above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10431regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
104329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10433is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10434
10435The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10436after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10437
10438Notes related to these keywords :
10439---------------------------------
10440 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10441 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10442 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10443
10444 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10445 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10446 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10447
10448 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10449 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10450 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10451 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10452 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10453
10454 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10455 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10456 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10457 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10458 useless headers before adding new ones.
10459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010460 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010461 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10462
10463 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10464 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10465 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10466
10467 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10468 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010469 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010470
10471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10473----------------------------------
10474
10475Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10476client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10477The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10478these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10479but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10480data called patterns.
10481
10482
104837.1. ACL basics
10484---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010485
10486The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10487content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10488from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10489simple :
10490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010491 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010492 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010493 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10494 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010496The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10497adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010498
10499In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010501 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010502
10503This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10504Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10505and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010506an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10507conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10508as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10509are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010510
10511ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10512'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10513which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10514
10515There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10516performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010518The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10519specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10520this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010521methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10522ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523
10524Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10525 - boolean
10526 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10527 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10528 - string
10529 - data block
10530
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010531Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10532converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10533would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10534The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10535which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10536
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010537Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10538keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10539fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10540which are summarized in the table below :
10541
10542 +---------------------+-----------------+
10543 | Sample or converter | Default |
10544 | output type | matching method |
10545 +---------------------+-----------------+
10546 | boolean | bool |
10547 +---------------------+-----------------+
10548 | integer | int |
10549 +---------------------+-----------------+
10550 | ip | ip |
10551 +---------------------+-----------------+
10552 | string | str |
10553 +---------------------+-----------------+
10554 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10555 +---------------------+-----------------+
10556
10557Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10558matching method, see below.
10559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10561 - boolean
10562 - integer or integer range
10563 - IP address / network
10564 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10565 - regular expression
10566 - hex block
10567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010568The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10569
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010570 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10571 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010573 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010574 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010575 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010576 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10579read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10580if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10581lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10582will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10583beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10584a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10585lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10586exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10587
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010588The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10589parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10590ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10591a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10592check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10593
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010594The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10595socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10596file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10599loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10600
10601 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10602
10603In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10604the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10605case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10606as well.
10607
10608The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10609sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10610do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10611methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10612is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10613obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10614followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10615default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10616that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10617string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10618
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010619The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10620By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10621string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10622resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10623server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10624waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10625flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10626function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10629sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10630be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010631
10632 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10633 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10635 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10636 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10637 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010638
10639 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10640 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010642
10643 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010645
10646 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010647 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010648
10649 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10650 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10651
10652 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10653 binary or string samples.
10654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10656 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010658 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10659 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10660 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010662 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10663 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10666 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10669 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10672 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010673 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10676 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10677 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010678
10679For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10680request, it is possible to do :
10681
10682 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10683
10684In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10685buffer, one would use the following acl :
10686
10687 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10688
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010689On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10690possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10691
10692 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10695criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10696method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10697to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10698criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10699the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010702the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10703For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010705 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10706 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10707 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10708 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010709
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010710
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010711The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10712types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10713combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10714brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10715default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717 +-------------------------------------------------+
10718 | Input sample type |
10719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010720 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10722 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10723 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010724 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010725 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010726 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010728 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010730 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010732 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010734 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010735 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010736 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010737 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010738 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010740 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010742 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010744 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10746 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010748
10749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107507.1.1. Matching booleans
10751------------------------
10752
10753In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10754Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10755When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10756that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10757
10758Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10759return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10760"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107637.1.2. Matching integers
10764------------------------
10765
10766Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10767enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10768to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10769
10770Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10771matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10772lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010773
10774For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10775unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10776representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10777
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010778As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10779two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10780instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10781ranges and operators.
10782
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010783For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010784operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10785Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10786of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010788Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010789
10790 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10791 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10792 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10793 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10794 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010796For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010797
10798 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10799
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010800This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10801
10802 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108057.1.3. Matching strings
10806-----------------------
10807
10808String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10809different forms :
10810
10811 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10812 patterns ;
10813
10814 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10815 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10816
10817 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10818 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10819
10820 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10821 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10822
10823 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10824 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10825 matches.
10826
10827 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10828 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10829 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010830
10831String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10832exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10833characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10834string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10835to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010836before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010837
10838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108397.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10840---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010841
10842Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10843they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10844possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10845passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10846the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010847the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10848match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010849
10850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108517.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10852-------------------------------------
10853
10854It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10855not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10856a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10857to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10858digits may be used upper or lower case.
10859
10860Example :
10861 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10862 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10863
10864
108657.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10866---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010867
10868IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10869netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10870within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010871host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010872difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10873at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10874does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10875parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010876
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010877IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10878Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10879trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10880IPv6 patterns.
10881
10882HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10883following situations :
10884 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10885 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10886 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10887 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10888 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10889 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10890 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10891 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10892 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10893 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010895
108967.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10897----------------------------------
10898
10899Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10900combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10901
10902 - AND (implicit)
10903 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10904 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010906A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010908 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10911indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10914"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10915requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10916is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10917
10918 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10919 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10920 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10921 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10922
10923To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10924and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10925
10926 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10927 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10928 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10929 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10930
10931 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10932 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10933 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10934 use_backend www if host_www
10935
10936It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10937expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10938be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10939the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10940
10941 The following rule :
10942
10943 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10944 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10945
10946 Can also be written that way :
10947
10948 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10949
10950It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10951to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10952simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10953sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10954good use is the following :
10955
10956 With named ACLs :
10957
10958 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10959 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10960 monitor fail if site_dead
10961
10962 With anonymous ACLs :
10963
10964 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10965
10966See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10967
10968
109697.3. Fetching samples
10970---------------------
10971
10972Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10973against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10974sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10975ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10976of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10977available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10978
10979This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10980Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10981compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10982deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10983
10984The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10985matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10986method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10987indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10988
10989As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10990when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10991mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10992the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10993ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10994
10995Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10996multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10997when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10998incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10999are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11000is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11001all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11002
11003Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11004 - name
11005 - name(arg1)
11006 - name(arg1,arg2)
11007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011008
110097.3.1. Converters
11010-----------------
11011
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011012Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11013of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11014is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11015was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11016has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11017unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11018
11019These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11020sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11021the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11022support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011023
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011024A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11025support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11026supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11027(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11028bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011031
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011032add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011033 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011034 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11035 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11036 allowed scopes are:
11037 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11038 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11039 response),
11040 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11041 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11042 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11043 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011044
11045and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011046 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011047 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11048 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11049 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11050 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11051 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11052 response),
11053 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11054 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11055 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11056 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011057
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011058base64
11059 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11060 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11061 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11062
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011063bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011064 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011065 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11066 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11067 presence of a flag).
11068
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011069bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11070 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11071 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11072 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11073
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011074cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011075 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11076 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011077
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011078crc32([<avalanche>])
11079 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11080 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11081 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11082 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11083 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11084 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11085 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11086 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11087 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11088 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11089 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11090
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011091da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11092 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11093 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11094 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11095 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11096 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11097 configuration language.
11098
11099 Example:
11100 frontend www
11101 bind *:8881
11102 default_backend servers
11103 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11104
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011105debug
11106 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11107 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11108 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11109
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011110div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011111 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11112 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011113 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11114 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11115 scope. The scope allowed are:
11116 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11117 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11118 response),
11119 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11120 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11121 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11122 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011123
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011124djb2([<avalanche>])
11125 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11126 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11127 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11128 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11129 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11130 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11131 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011132 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11133 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011134
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011135even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011136 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011137 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11138
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011139field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11140 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11141 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11142 list of chars.
11143
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011144hex
11145 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11146 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11147 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11148 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011149
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011150http_date([<offset>])
11151 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11152 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11153 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11154 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11155 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11156 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011158in_table(<table>)
11159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11161 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11162 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11163 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11164
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011165ipmask(<mask>)
11166 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11167 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11168 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11169 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11170
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011171json([<input-code>])
11172 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11173 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11174 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11175 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11176 of errors:
11177 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11178 bytes, ...)
11179 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11180 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11181
11182 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11183 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11184 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11185 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11186 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11187 are :
11188 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11189 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11190 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11191 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11192 error ;
11193 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11194 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11195
11196 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11197 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11198
11199 Example:
11200 capture request header user-agent len 150
11201 capture request header Host len 15
11202 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11203
11204 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11205 GET / HTTP/1.0
11206 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11207
11208 Output log:
11209 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11210
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011211language(<value>[,<default>])
11212 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11213 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11214 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11215 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11216 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11217 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11218 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11219 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11220 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11221 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11222 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11223 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011224
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011225 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011226
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011227 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11228 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011229
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011230 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11231 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11232 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11233 use_backend spanish if es
11234 use_backend french if fr
11235 use_backend english if en
11236 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011237
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011238lower
11239 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11240 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11241 type. The result is of type string.
11242
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011243ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11244 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11245 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11246 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11247 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11248 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11249 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11250
11251 Example :
11252
11253 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11254 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11255 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11256
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011257map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11258map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11259map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11260 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11261 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11262 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11263 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11264 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11265 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11266 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11267 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011269 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11270 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11271 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011272
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011273 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11274 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011275
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011276 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11277 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11278 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11279 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011280 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11281 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011282 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11283 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11284 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11285 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11286 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11287 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11288 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11289 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11290 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11291 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11292 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11293 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11294 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11295 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011296
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011297 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11298 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11299 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11300 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11301 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011302
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011303 Example :
11304
11305 # this is a comment and is ignored
11306 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11307 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11308 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11309 | | | `---------- value
11310 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11311 | `---------------------------- key
11312 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11313
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011314mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011315 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11316 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011317 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11318 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11319 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11320 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11321 response),
11322 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11323 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11324 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11325 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011326
11327mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011328 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011329 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11330 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011331 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11332 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11333 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11334 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11335 response),
11336 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11337 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11339 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011340
11341neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011342 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11343 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11344 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11345 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011346
11347not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011348 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011349 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11350 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11351 absence of a flag).
11352
11353odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011354 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011355 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11356
11357or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011358 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011359 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11360 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11361 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11362 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11363 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11364 response),
11365 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11366 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11367 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11368 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011369
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011370regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011371 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11372 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11373 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11374 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11375 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11376 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11377 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11378 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11379 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11380 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11381 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11382 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11383 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11384
11385 Example :
11386
11387 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11388 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11389 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11390 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11391
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011392capture-req(<id>)
11393 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11394 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11395
11396 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11397 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11398 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11399
11400capture-res(<id>)
11401 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11402 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11403
11404 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11405 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11406 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11407
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011408sdbm([<avalanche>])
11409 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11410 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11411 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11412 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11413 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11414 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11415 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011416 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11417 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011418
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011419set-var(<var name>)
11420 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11421 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11422 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11423 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11424 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11425 response),
11426 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11427 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11428 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11429 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11430
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011431sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011432 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11433 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011434 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11435 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11436 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11437 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11438 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11439 response),
11440 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11441 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11442 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11443 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011444
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011445table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11449 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11450 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11451 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11452
11453
11454table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11458 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11459 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11460 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11461
11462table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11463 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11464 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11465 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11466 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11467 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11468
11469table_conn_cur(<table>)
11470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11473 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11474 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11475
11476table_conn_rate(<table>)
11477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11480 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11481 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11482
11483table_gpc0(<table>)
11484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11487 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11488 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11489
11490table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11491 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11492 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11493 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11494 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11495 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11496 sample fetch keyword.
11497
11498table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11499 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11500 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11501 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11502 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11503 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11504
11505table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11506 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11507 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11508 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11509 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11510 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11511 keyword.
11512
11513table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11514 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11515 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11516 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11517 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11518 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11519
11520table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11523 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11524 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11525 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11526 keyword.
11527
11528table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11529 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11530 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11531 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11532 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11533 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11534 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11535 keyword.
11536
11537table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11538 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11539 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11540 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11541 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11542 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11543 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11544 keyword.
11545
11546table_server_id(<table>)
11547 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11548 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11549 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11550 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11551 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11552 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11553
11554table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11555 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11556 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11557 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11558 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11559 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11560 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11561 keyword.
11562
11563table_sess_rate(<table>)
11564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11566 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11567 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11568 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11569 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11570 keyword.
11571
11572table_trackers(<table>)
11573 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11574 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11575 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11576 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11577 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11578 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11579 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11580 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11581 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11582 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11583
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011584upper
11585 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11586 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11587 type. The result is of type string.
11588
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011589url_dec
11590 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11591 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11592
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011593utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11594 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11595 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11596 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11597 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11598 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11599 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11600
11601 Example :
11602
11603 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11604 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11605 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11606
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011607word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11608 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11609 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11610
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011611wt6([<avalanche>])
11612 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11613 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11614 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11615 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11616 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11617 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11618 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011619 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11620 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011621
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011622xor(<value>)
11623 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011624 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011625 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11626 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11627 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11628 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11629 response),
11630 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11631 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11632 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11633 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011634
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011635
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116367.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011637--------------------------------------------
11638
11639A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11640not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11641"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11642The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11643
11644always_false : boolean
11645 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11646 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11647
11648always_true : boolean
11649 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11650 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11651
11652avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011653 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011654 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11655 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11656 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11657 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11658 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11659 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11660 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11661 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11662 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11663 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11664 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11665 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11666 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011668be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011669 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11670 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11671 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11672 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11673 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011675be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11677 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11678 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11679 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11680 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11681 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011682
11683 Example :
11684 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11685 backend dynamic
11686 mode http
11687 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11688 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011689
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011690bin(<hexa>) : bin
11691 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
11692 of the string.
11693
11694bool(<bool>) : bool
11695 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
11696 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
11697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011698connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011700 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011701 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11702 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011703
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011704 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011705 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011706 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11707
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011708 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11709 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011710
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011711 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011712 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011714 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11715 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011716 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011717 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011718
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011719 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11720 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011721 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011722 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011723
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011724date([<offset>]) : integer
11725 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11726 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11727 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11728 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011729 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11730
11731 Example :
11732
11733 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11734 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011735
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011736env(<name>) : string
11737 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11738 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11739 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11740 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11741 certain way.
11742
11743 Examples :
11744 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11745 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11746
11747 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11748 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11751 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011752 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11753 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11755 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11756 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11757 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11758 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11762 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11763 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11764 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11765 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11766 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11767 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11768 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011769
11770 Example :
11771 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11772 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11773 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11774 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11775 frontend mail
11776 bind :25
11777 mode tcp
11778 maxconn 100
11779 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11780 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11781 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11782 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011783
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011784int(<integer>) : signed integer
11785 Returns a signed integer.
11786
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011787ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
11788 Returns an ipv4.
11789
11790ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
11791 Returns an ipv6.
11792
11793meth(<method>) : method
11794 Returns a method.
11795
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011796nbproc : integer
11797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11798 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11799 and debugging purposes.
11800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11802 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11803 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11804 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011805 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11806 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11807 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011808
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011809proc : integer
11810 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11811 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11812 debugging purposes.
11813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011815 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11816 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11817 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011818 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11819 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11820 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11821 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11822 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11823
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011824rand([<range>]) : integer
11825 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11826 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11827 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11828 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11829 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011831srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11832 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11833 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11834 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11835 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11836 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11837 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11838 methods.
11839
11840srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11841 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11842 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11843 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11844 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11845 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11846 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11847 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11848
11849srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11850 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11851 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011852 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011853 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11854 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11855 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11856 overloading servers).
11857
11858 Example :
11859 # Redirect to a separate back
11860 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11861 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11862 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11863
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011864stopping : boolean
11865 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11866 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11867 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11868
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011869str(<string>) : string
11870 Returns a string.
11871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011872table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11873 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11874 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11875
11876table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11877 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11878 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11879 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11880
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011881var(<var-name>) : undefined
11882 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11883 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11884 scope. The scope allowed are:
11885 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11886 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11887 response),
11888 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11889 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11890 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11891 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118947.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895----------------------------------
11896
11897The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11898closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11899methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11900sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11901TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011902the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11903counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11904"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011905argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11906the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11907this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011908
11909be_id : integer
11910 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11911 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11912
11913dst : ip
11914 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11915 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11916 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11917 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11918 RFC 4291.
11919
11920dst_conn : integer
11921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11922 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11923 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11924 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11925 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11926 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11927 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11928 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011930dst_port : integer
11931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11932 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11933 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11934 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11935 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11936 an HTTP header.
11937
11938fe_id : integer
11939 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11940 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11941 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011943sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011944sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11945sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11946sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011947 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11948 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11949 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011951sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011952sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11953sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11954sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011955 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11956 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11957 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011959sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011960sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11961sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11962sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011963 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11964 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011965 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11966 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11967 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011968
11969 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11970 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011971 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11972 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11973 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011974 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11975 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011977sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011978sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11979sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11980sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011981 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11982 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11983
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011984sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011985sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11986sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11987sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011988 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11989 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11990 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11991
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011992sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011993sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11994sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11995sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011996 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11997 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11998 See also src_conn_rate.
11999
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012000sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012001sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12002sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12003sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012004 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012005 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012007sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012008sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12009sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12010sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012011 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12012 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12013 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012014 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12015 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12016 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012017
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012018sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012019sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12020sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12021sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12023 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12024 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12025
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012026sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012027sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12028sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12029sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012030 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12031 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12032 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12033 src_http_err_rate.
12034
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012035sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012036sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12037sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12038sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012039 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12040 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12041 src_http_req_cnt.
12042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012043sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012044sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12045sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12046sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012047 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12048 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12049 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12050 src_http_req_rate.
12051
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012052sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012053sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12054sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12055sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012056 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012057 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12058 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12059 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12060 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012061
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012062 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12063 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012064 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012066sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012067sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12068sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12069sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012070 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012074sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012075sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12076sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12077sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012078 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12079 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12080 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012082sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012083sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12084sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12085sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012086 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12087 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12088 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12089 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012090 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012093sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012094sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12095sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12096sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012097 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12098 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12099 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12100 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12101 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012102 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012104sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012105sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12106sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12107sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012108 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12109 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12110 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012112sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012113sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12114sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12115sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012116 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12117 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012118 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012119 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12120 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12122 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12123 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125so_id : integer
12126 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12127 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12128 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130src : ip
12131 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12132 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12133 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12134 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12135 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12136 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12137 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012138
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012139 Example:
12140 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12141 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012143src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12144 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12145 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12146 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012147 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012149src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12150 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12151 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012152 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012153 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12156 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12157 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12158 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12159 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12160 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12161 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012162
12163 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12164 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12165 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12166 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012167 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012168 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12169 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012172 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012173 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012174 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012175 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012178 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012179 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12180 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012181 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012183src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12184 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12185 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12186 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012187 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012190 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012191 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012192 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012193 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012195src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012196 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012197 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012198 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12199 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012200 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12201 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12202 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012204src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12205 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12206 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012207 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012208 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012209 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012211src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12212 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12213 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12214 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12215 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012216 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012218src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12219 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12220 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12221 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012222 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012224src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12225 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12226 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12227 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012228 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012229 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12232 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12233 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12234 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012235 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012236 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12237 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012238
12239 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012240 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012241 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012244 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12245 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12246 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12247 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12248 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012250src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012251 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12252 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12253 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12254 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12255 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012257src_port : integer
12258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12259 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12260 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12261 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012263src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12264 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012265 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12266 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12267 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012268 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012270src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12271 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12272 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12273 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12274 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012275 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012277src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12278 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12279 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12280 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12281 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12282 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12283 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12284 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12285 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012286
12287 Example :
12288 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12289 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12290 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12291 listen ssh
12292 bind :22
12293 mode tcp
12294 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012295 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012297 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012299srv_id : integer
12300 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12301 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12302 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012303
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123057.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012306----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12309closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12310when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12311usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012312future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012313
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012314ssl_bc : boolean
12315 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12316 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12317 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12318
12319ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12320 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12321 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12322
12323ssl_bc_cipher : string
12324 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12325 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12326
12327ssl_bc_protocol : string
12328 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12329 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12330
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012331ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012332 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012333 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12334 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012335
12336ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12337 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12338 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12339 if session was reused or not.
12340
12341ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12342 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12343 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012345ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12347 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12348 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12349 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12350 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12353 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12354 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12355 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12356 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012357
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012358ssl_c_der : binary
12359 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12360 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12361 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363ssl_c_err : integer
12364 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12365 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12366 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12367 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12368 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012370ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12371 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12372 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12373 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12374 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12375 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12376 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12377 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12378 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012380ssl_c_key_alg : string
12381 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12382 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12383 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012385ssl_c_notafter : string
12386 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12387 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12388 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012390ssl_c_notbefore : string
12391 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12392 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12393 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012395ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12396 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12397 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12398 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12399 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12400 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12401 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12402 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12403 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012405ssl_c_serial : binary
12406 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12407 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12408 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012410ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12411 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12412 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12413 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012414 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12415 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12416
12417 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12420 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12421 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12422 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012424ssl_c_used : boolean
12425 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12426 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428ssl_c_verify : integer
12429 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12430 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12431 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12432 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434ssl_c_version : integer
12435 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12436 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012437
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012438ssl_f_der : binary
12439 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12440 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12441 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012443ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12444 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12445 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12446 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12447 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012448 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012449 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12450 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12451 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012453ssl_f_key_alg : string
12454 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12455 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12456 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012458ssl_f_notafter : string
12459 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12460 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12461 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012463ssl_f_notbefore : string
12464 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12465 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12466 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012468ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12469 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12470 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12471 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12472 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12473 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12474 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12475 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12476 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478ssl_f_serial : binary
12479 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12480 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12481 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012482
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012483ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12484 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12485 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12486 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12489 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12490 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12491 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012493ssl_f_version : integer
12494 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12495 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12496
12497ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012498 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12499 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12500 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012502 Example :
12503 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12504 listen http-https
12505 bind :80
12506 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12507 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12508
12509ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12512
12513ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012514 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12516 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12517 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12518 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12519 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12520 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12521 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12522 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012524ssl_fc_cipher : string
12525 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12526 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012529 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12530 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012531 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12532 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12533 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12534 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012536ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12537 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012538 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12539 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12540 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12541 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012542
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012543ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12544 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12545 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012547ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012548 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012549 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12550 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12551 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12552 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12553 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12554 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12555 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012557ssl_fc_protocol : string
12558 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12559 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012560
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012561ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012562 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012563 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12564 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012566ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12567 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12568 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12569 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12570 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572ssl_fc_sni : string
12573 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12574 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12575 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12576 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12577 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12578
12579 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12580 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12581 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012582 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12583 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12587 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12590 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12591 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012592
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012593
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125947.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012595------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012597Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12598sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12599only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12600For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12601be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12602can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12603sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12604for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12605content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12608 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12609 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12610 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012612payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12613 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12614 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12615 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617req.len : integer
12618req_len : integer (deprecated)
12619 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12620 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12621 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12622 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12623 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12624 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12625 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12626 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012628req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12629 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012630 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12631 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12632 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12633 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012635 ACL alternatives :
12636 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012638req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12639 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12640 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12641 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12642 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644 ACL alternatives :
12645 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012649req.proto_http : boolean
12650req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12651 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12652 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12653 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12654 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12655 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12656 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12657 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012659 Example:
12660 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12661 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12662 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012663 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12666rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12667 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12668 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12669 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12670 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12671 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12672 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12673 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012675 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12676 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12677 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12678 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12679 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12680 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682 ACL derivatives :
12683 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012685 Example :
12686 listen tse-farm
12687 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12688 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12689 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12690 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12691 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12692 persist rdp-cookie
12693 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12694 # This is only useful makes sense if
12695 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12696 stick-table type string size 204800
12697 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12698 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12699 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12702 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012704req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12705rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12706 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12707 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12708 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12709 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012711 ACL derivatives :
12712 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012713
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020012714req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
12715 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
12716 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
12717 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC certificate
12718 and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that this only
12719 applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to contents
12720 deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines
12721 having the "ssl" option.
12722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12724req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12725 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12726 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12727 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12728 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12729 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12730 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12731 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733req.ssl_sni : string
12734req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12735 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12736 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12737 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12738 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12739 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12740 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12741 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12742 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12743 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12744 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12745 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12746 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748 ACL derivatives :
12749 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751 Examples :
12752 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12753 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12754 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12755 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12756 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12759rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12760 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12761 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12762 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12763 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12764 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12765 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12766 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768req.ssl_ver : integer
12769req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12770 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12771 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12772 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12773 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12774 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12775 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12776 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12777 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12778 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780 ACL derivatives :
12781 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012782
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012783res.len : integer
12784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12785 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12786 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12787 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12788 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12789 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12790 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12791 content inspection.
12792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012793res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12794 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012795 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12796 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12797 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12798 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012800res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12801 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12802 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12803 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12804 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012806 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012808wait_end : boolean
12809 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12810 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12811 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12812 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12813 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12814 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12815 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12816 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818 Examples :
12819 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12820 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12821 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12824 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12825 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12826 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12827 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12828 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12829 tcp-request content reject
12830
12831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833--------------------------------------
12834
12835It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12836This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12837data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12838its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12839HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12840content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12841to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12842more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12843response are indexed.
12844
12845base : string
12846 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12847 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12848 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12849 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12850 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12851 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12852 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12853 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12854
12855 ACL derivatives :
12856 base : exact string match
12857 base_beg : prefix match
12858 base_dir : subdir match
12859 base_dom : domain match
12860 base_end : suffix match
12861 base_len : length match
12862 base_reg : regex match
12863 base_sub : substring match
12864
12865base32 : integer
12866 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12867 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12868 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012869 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12870 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12871 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872
12873base32+src : binary
12874 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12875 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12876 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12877 per-URL counters.
12878
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012879capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12880 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12881 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12882 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12883
12884capture.req.method : string
12885 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12886 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12887 because it's allocated.
12888
12889capture.req.uri : string
12890 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12891 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12892 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12893 allocated.
12894
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012895capture.req.ver : string
12896 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12897 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12898 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12899
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012900capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12901 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12902 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12903 The first entry is an index of 0.
12904 See also: "capture response header"
12905
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012906capture.res.ver : string
12907 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12908 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12909 persistent flag.
12910
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012911req.body : binary
12912 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12913 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12914 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12915 the first chunk is analyzed.
12916
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012917req.body_param([<name>) : string
12918 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12919 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12920 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12921 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12922 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12923 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12924 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12925 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12926 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12927 given.
12928
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012929req.body_len : integer
12930 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12931 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12932 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12933 "option http-buffer-request".
12934
12935req.body_size : integer
12936 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12937 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12938 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12939 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12940 "option http-buffer-request".
12941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942req.cook([<name>]) : string
12943cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12944 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12945 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12946 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12947 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12948 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12949 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12950 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12951 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12952
12953 ACL derivatives :
12954 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12955 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12956 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12957 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12958 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12959 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12960 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12961 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12964cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12965 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12966 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12969cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12970 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12971 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12972 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12973 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12976 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12977 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12978 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12979 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12980 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12981 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12982 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12983 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12984 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12985 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12988 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12989 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12990 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12991 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012992 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12996 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12997 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12998 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12999 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13000 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13001 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13002 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13005 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13006 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13007 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13008 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13011 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13012 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13013 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13014 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13015 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13016 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13017 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13018 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13019 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13020 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13021 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023 ACL derivatives :
13024 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13025 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13026 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13027 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13028 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13029 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13030 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13031 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13032
13033req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13034hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13035 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13036 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13037 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13038 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13039 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13040 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13041 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13042 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13043 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13044
13045req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13046hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13047 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13048 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13049 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13050 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13051 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13052 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13053 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13054 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13055
13056req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13057hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13058 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13059 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13060 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13061 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13062 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13063 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13064 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13065
13066http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13067 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13068 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13069 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13070 basic auth is supported.
13071
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013072http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13073 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13074 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13075 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13076 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13078 basic auth is supported.
13079
13080 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013081 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13082 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13083 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13084 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085
13086http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013087 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13088 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13090 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092method : integer + string
13093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13094 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13095 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13096 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13097 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13098 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13099 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101 ACL derivatives :
13102 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 Example :
13105 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13106 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13107 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109path : string
13110 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13111 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13112 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13113 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13114 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13115 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13116 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118 ACL derivatives :
13119 path : exact string match
13120 path_beg : prefix match
13121 path_dir : subdir match
13122 path_dom : domain match
13123 path_end : suffix match
13124 path_len : length match
13125 path_reg : regex match
13126 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013127
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013128query : string
13129 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13130 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13131 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13132 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13133 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13134 which stops before the question mark.
13135
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013136req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13137 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13138 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13139 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13140 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142req.ver : string
13143req_ver : string (deprecated)
13144 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13145 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13146 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148 ACL derivatives :
13149 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151res.comp : boolean
13152 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13153 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13154 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156res.comp_algo : string
13157 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13158 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13159 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161res.cook([<name>]) : string
13162scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13163 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13164 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13165 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167 ACL derivatives :
13168 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13171scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13172 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13173 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13174 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013176res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13177scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13178 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13179 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13180 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13183 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13184 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13185 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13186 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13187 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13188 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13189 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13190 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13191 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013193res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13194 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13195 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13196 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13197 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13198 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13201shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13203 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13204 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13205 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13206 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13207 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13208 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13209 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211 ACL derivatives :
13212 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13213 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13214 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13215 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13216 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13217 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13218 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13219 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13220
13221res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13222shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13223 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13224 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13225 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13226 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13227 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13230shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13231 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13232 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13233 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13234 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13235 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13236 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013237
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013238res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13239 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13240 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13241 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13242 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13245shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13246 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13247 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13248 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13249 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13250 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13251 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253res.ver : string
13254resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13255 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13256 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258 ACL derivatives :
13259 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13262 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13263 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
13264 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
13265 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13268 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272status : integer
13273 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13274 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13275 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277url : string
13278 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13279 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13280 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13281 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13282 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13283 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13284 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286 ACL derivatives :
13287 url : exact string match
13288 url_beg : prefix match
13289 url_dir : subdir match
13290 url_dom : domain match
13291 url_end : suffix match
13292 url_len : length match
13293 url_reg : regex match
13294 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296url_ip : ip
13297 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13298 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13299 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13300 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13301 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13302 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13303 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013305url_port : integer
13306 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13307 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13308 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13309 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013310
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013311urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13312url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13314 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013315 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13316 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13317 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13318 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13320 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013321 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13322 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013324 ACL derivatives :
13325 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13326 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13327 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13328 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13329 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13330 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13331 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13332 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013333
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335 Example :
13336 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13337 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13338 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13339 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013340
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013341urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13343 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13344 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013345
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133477.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013348---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013350Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13351every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013352order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013354ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13355---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013356FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013357HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013358HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13359HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013360HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13361HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13362HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13363HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13364LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013365METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13366METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13367METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13368METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13369METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13370METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013371RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013372REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013373TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013374WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13375---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013376
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133788. Logging
13379----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013380
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013381One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13382provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13383very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13384provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13385state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013386to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013387headers.
13388
13389In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13390about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13391send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13392
13393 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13394 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13395 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13396 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13397 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013398 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13399 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013400
13401The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13402allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13403as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13404while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13405real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13406delay.
13407
13408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134098.1. Log levels
13410---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013411
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013412TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013413source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013414HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13415in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13416track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13417syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13418about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013419
13420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134218.2. Log formats
13422----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013423
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013424HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013425and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13426slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13427options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013428
13429 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13430 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13431 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13432 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13433 extents.
13434
13435 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13436 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13437 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13438 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13439 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13440
13441 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13442 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13443 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13444 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13445 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13446
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013447 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13448 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13449 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13450 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13451
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013452 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13453
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013454Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13455specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13456field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13457servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13458always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13459identifier.
13460
13461Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13462 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13463 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13464 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13465 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13466
13467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134688.2.1. Default log format
13469-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013470
13471This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13472as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13473format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13474
13475 Example :
13476 listen www
13477 mode http
13478 log global
13479 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13480
13481 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13482 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13483 (www/HTTP)
13484
13485 Field Format Extract from the example above
13486 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13487 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13488 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13489 4 'to' to
13490 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13491 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13492
13493Detailed fields description :
13494 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13495 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13496 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13497 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13498 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13499 and processed the connection.
13500 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13501
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013502In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13503"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13504connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13505
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013506It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13507will eventually disappear.
13508
13509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135108.2.2. TCP log format
13511---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013512
13513The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13514is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13515information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13516counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13517emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13518environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13519the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13520sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013521specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13522not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13523fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13524marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013525
13526 Example :
13527 frontend fnt
13528 mode tcp
13529 option tcplog
13530 log global
13531 default_backend bck
13532
13533 backend bck
13534 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13535
13536 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13537 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13538 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13539
13540 Field Format Extract from the example above
13541 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13542 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13543 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13544 4 frontend_name fnt
13545 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13546 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13547 7 bytes_read* 212
13548 8 termination_state --
13549 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13550 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13551
13552Detailed fields description :
13553 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013554 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13555 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13556 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13557 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13558 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013559
13560 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013561 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13562 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13563 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013564
13565 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13566 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13567 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13568 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13569
13570 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13571 and processed the connection.
13572
13573 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13574 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13575 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13576 applications.
13577
13578 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13579 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13580 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13581 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13582 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13583
13584 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13585 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13586 See "Timers" below for more details.
13587
13588 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13589 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13590 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13591 "Timers" below for more details.
13592
13593 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013594 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013595 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13596 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13597 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13598 details.
13599
13600 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13601 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13602 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13603 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13604 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13605
13606 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13607 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13608 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13609 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13610 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13611 for more details.
13612
13613 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013614 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013615 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13616 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13617 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013618 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013619
13620 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13621 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13622 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13623 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13624 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13625 caused by a denial of service attack.
13626
13627 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13628 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13629 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13630 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13631 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13632 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13633 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13634 denial of service attack.
13635
13636 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13637 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13638 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13639 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13640 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13641 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13642 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13643 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13644 be processed than on other servers.
13645
13646 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13647 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13648 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13649 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13650 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13651 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13652 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13653 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13654 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13655 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13656 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13657 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13658 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13659
13660 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13661 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13662 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13663 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13664 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13665 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13666 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13667 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13668
13669 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13670 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13671 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13672 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13673 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13674 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13675 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13676 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13677 occurs.
13678
13679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136808.2.3. HTTP log format
13681----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013682
13683The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13684is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13685the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13686are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13687emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13688generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13689"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13690which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013691frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13692is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013693
13694Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13695slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13696with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13697
13698 Example :
13699 frontend http-in
13700 mode http
13701 option httplog
13702 log global
13703 default_backend bck
13704
13705 backend static
13706 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13707
13708 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13709 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13710 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013711 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013712
13713 Field Format Extract from the example above
13714 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13715 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13716 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13717 4 frontend_name http-in
13718 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13719 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13720 7 status_code 200
13721 8 bytes_read* 2750
13722 9 captured_request_cookie -
13723 10 captured_response_cookie -
13724 11 termination_state ----
13725 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13726 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13727 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13728 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13729 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013731
13732Detailed fields description :
13733 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013734 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13735 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13736 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13737 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13738 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013739
13740 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013741 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13742 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13743 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013744
13745 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13746 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13747 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13748 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13749 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13750
13751 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13752 and processed the connection.
13753
13754 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13755 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13756 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13757
13758 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13759 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13760 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13761 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13762 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13763 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13764
13765 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13766 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13767 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13768 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13769 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13770 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13771
13772 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13773 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13774 See "Timers" below for more details.
13775
13776 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13777 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13778 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13779 below for more details.
13780
13781 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13782 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13783 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13784 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13785 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13786 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13787 for more details.
13788
13789 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013790 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013791 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13792 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13793 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13794 details.
13795
13796 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13797 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13798 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13799
13800 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13801 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13802 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13803 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13804 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13805 overflowing.
13806
13807 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13808 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13809 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13810 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13811 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13812 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13813 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13814 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13815
13816 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13817 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13818 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13819 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13820 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13821 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13822 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13823 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13824
13825 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13826 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13827 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13828 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13829 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13830 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13831 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13832
13833 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013834 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013835 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13836 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13837 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013838 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013839 system.
13840
13841 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13842 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13843 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13844 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13845 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13846 caused by a denial of service attack.
13847
13848 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13849 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13850 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13851 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13852 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13853 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13854 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13855 denial of service attack.
13856
13857 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13858 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13859 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13860 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13861 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13862 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13863 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13864 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13865 processed than on other servers.
13866
13867 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13868 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13869 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13870 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13871 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13872 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13873 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13874 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13875 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13876 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13877 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13878 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13879 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13880
13881 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13882 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13883 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13884 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13885 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13886 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13887 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13888 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13889
13890 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13891 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13892 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13893 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13894 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13895 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13896 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13897 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13898 occurs.
13899
13900 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13901 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13902 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13903 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13904 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13905 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13906 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13907 cookies" below for more details.
13908
13909 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13910 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13911 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13912 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13913 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13914 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13915 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13916 and cookies" below for more details.
13917
13918 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13919 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13920 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13921 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13922 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13923 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13924 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13925 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13926
13927
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200139288.2.4. Custom log format
13929------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013930
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013931The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013932mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013933
13934HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13935Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13936separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13937prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13938
13939Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13940variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13941string formats ("Q").
13942
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013943If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013944as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013945less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13946the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13947
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013948Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013949In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013950in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013951
13952Flags are :
13953 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013954 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013955
13956 Example:
13957
13958 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13959 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13960
13961At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13962
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013963 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13964 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013965
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013966the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013967
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013968 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013969 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013970 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013971
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013972and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13973
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013974 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013975 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13976
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013977Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13978
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013979 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013980 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013981 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13982 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13983 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013984 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13985 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13986 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013987 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013988 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13989 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13990 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13991 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013992 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013993 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013994 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013995 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013996 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013997 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13998 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013999 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014000 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14001 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014002 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014003 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14004 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014005 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14006 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14007 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014008 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014009 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14010 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014011 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014012 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14013 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14014 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014015 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014016 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014017 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14018 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14019 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14020 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014021 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014022 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014023 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014024 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014025 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014026 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014027 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14028 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14029 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014030 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014031 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14032 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014033 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014034 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014035 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014036 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014037
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014038 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014039
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014040
140418.2.5. Error log format
14042-----------------------
14043
14044When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14045protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14046By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14047"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14048will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14049logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14050
14051The format looks like this :
14052
14053 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14054 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14055 Connection error during SSL handshake
14056
14057 Field Format Extract from the example above
14058 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14059 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14060 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14061 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14062 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14063
14064These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14065failures.
14066
14067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140688.3. Advanced logging options
14069-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014070
14071Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14072just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14073options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14074for more information about their usage.
14075
14076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14078------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014079
14080It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14081haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14082commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14083monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14084ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14085
14086 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14087 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14088 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14089 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14090
14091 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14092 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14093 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014094 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014095 such as other load-balancers.
14096
14097 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14098 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14099 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14100
14101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14103----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014104
14105The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14106what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14107or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14108"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14109just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14110log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14111after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14112is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14113with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14114with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14115
14116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14118------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014119
14120Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14121for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14122"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14123retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14124raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14125a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14126file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14127you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14128"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14129
14130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14132--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014133
14134Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14135multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14136them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14137"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14138logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14139error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14140and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14141too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14142useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14143alternative.
14144
14145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141468.4. Timing events
14147------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014148
14149Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14150reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14151the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14152frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14153mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14154
14155 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14156 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14157 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14158 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14159 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14160
14161 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14162 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14163 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14164 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14165 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14166
14167 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14168 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14169 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14170 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14171 connection never established.
14172
14173 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14174 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14175 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14176 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14177 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14178 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14179 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14180 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14181 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14182 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14183 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14184
14185 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14186 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14187 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14188 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014189 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014190
14191 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14192
14193 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14194 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14195 negative.
14196
14197These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14198protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14199that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014200due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014201close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14202session has been aborted on timeout.
14203
14204Most common cases :
14205
14206 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14207 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14208 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14209 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14210 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14211 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14212 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14213 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14214 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014215 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14216 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14217 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014218
14219 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14220 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14221 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14222 of ms on remote networks.
14223
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014224 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14225 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14226 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014227
14228 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14229 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14230 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14231 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14232 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14233 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14234 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14235 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14236 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14237 to the server until another one is released.
14238
14239Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14240
14241 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14242 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14243 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14244
14245 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14246 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14247 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14248
14249 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14250 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14251 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14252 flags.
14253
14254 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14255 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14256 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14257 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14258 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14259 the client connection was maintained open.
14260
14261 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014262 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014263 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14264 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14265
14266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142678.5. Session state at disconnection
14268-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014269
14270TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14271"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
142722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14273each of which has a special meaning :
14274
14275 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14276 session to terminate :
14277
14278 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14279
14280 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14281 server explicitly refused it.
14282
14283 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14284 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14285 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14286 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014287 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14288
14289 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14290 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014291
14292 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14293 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14294 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14295 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14296 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14297
14298 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14299 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14300 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14301 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14302 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14303
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014304 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14305 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14306
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014307 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14308 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14309 backup connections when going up.
14310
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014311 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014313 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14314 send or receive data.
14315
14316 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14317 send or receive data.
14318
14319 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14320 with nothing left in the buffers.
14321
14322 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14323
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014324 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014325 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14326
14327 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14328 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14329 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14330 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14331 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14332
14333 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14334 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14335
14336 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14337 server (HTTP only).
14338
14339 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14340
14341 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14342 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14343 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14344
14345 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14346 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14347 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14348
14349 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14350
14351 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14352 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14353
14354 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14355 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14356 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14357
14358 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14359 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014360 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14361 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014362
14363 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14364 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14365 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14366 another server.
14367
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014368 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014369 server.
14370
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014371 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14372 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14373 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14374 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14375
14376 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14377 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14378 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14379 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14380
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014381 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14382 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14383 "use-server" rule).
14384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014385 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14386
14387 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14388 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14389
14390 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14391
14392 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14393 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14394 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014396 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14397 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014398 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014399 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14400 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014402 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14403
14404 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14405 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14406
14407 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14408
14409 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14410
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014411The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14412was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014413helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14414starvation, attacks, etc...
14415
14416The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14417alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14418easier finding and understanding.
14419
14420 Flags Reason
14421
14422 -- Normal termination.
14423
14424 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14425 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14426 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14427 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14428
14429 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14430 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14431 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14432 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14433 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14434 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014436 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14437 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014438 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014439
14440 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14441 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14442 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14443
14444 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14445 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14446 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14447 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14448 the server takes too long to respond.
14449
14450 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14451 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14452 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14453 long a time to respond.
14454
14455 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14456 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14457 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14458 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014459 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14460 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014461
14462 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14463 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14464 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14465 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14466 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014467 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014468 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14469 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14470 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14471 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14472 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14473 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14474 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14475 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14476 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14477 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14478 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14479 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014480
14481 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14482 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014483 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14484 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14485 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14486 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014487
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014488 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14489 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014491 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014492 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14493 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14494 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14495 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14496 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14497
14498 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14499 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14500 503 or 504 here.
14501
14502 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14503 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14504 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14505 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14506 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14507
14508 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14509 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014510 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014511 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14512 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14513
14514 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14515 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14516 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14517 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14518 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14519 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14520 between haproxy and the server.
14521
14522 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14523 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14524 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14525 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14526 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14527 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14528 solution is to fix the application.
14529
14530 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14531 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14532 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14533 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14534 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14535 external attacks.
14536
14537 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14538 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014539 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014540 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14541 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14542
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014543 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14544 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14545 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014546 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14547 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014548
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014549 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14550 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14551 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14552 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014553 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14554 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14555 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14556 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14557 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014558
14559 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14560 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14561 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14562 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14563
14564 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14565 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14566 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14567 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14568
14569 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14570 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14571 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14572 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14573
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014574The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14575persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14576important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14577re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14578
14579 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14580
14581 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14582 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14583 set on a GET request.
14584
14585 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14586 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014587 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014588 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14589
14590 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14591 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14592 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14593
14594 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14595 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14596 already got a cookie.
14597
14598 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14599 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14600 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14601 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14602 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14603
14604 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14605 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14606 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14607
14608 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14609 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14610 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14611
14612 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14613 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14614
14615 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14616 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14617 then advertised in the response.
14618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146208.6. Non-printable characters
14621-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014622
14623In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14624consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14625converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14626prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14627being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14628escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14629is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14630'}' when logging headers.
14631
14632Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14633issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14634containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14635
14636Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14637the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14638performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14639
14640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14642---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014643
14644Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14645achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014646section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014647cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14648the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14649the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014650locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014651not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14652user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14653a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14654wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14655
14656 Examples :
14657 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14658 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14659
14660 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14661 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14662
14663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14665---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014666
14667Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14668proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14669the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14670server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14671
14672Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14673response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014674section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014675
14676It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014677time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14678appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014679are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14680and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14681follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14682request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14683in the logs.
14684
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014685As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14686frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14687an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014689 Example :
14690 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14691 listen proxy-out
14692 mode http
14693 option httplog
14694 option logasap
14695 log global
14696 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14697
14698 # log the name of the virtual server
14699 capture request header Host len 20
14700
14701 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14702 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14703
14704 # log the beginning of the referrer
14705 capture request header Referer len 20
14706
14707 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14708 capture response header Server len 20
14709
14710 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14711 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14712
14713 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14714 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14715
14716 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14717 capture response header Via len 20
14718
14719 # log the URL location during a redirection
14720 capture response header Location len 20
14721
14722 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14723 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14724 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14725 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14726 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14727
14728 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14729 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14730 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14731 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014732 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014733
14734 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14735 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14736 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14737 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14738 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014739 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014740
14741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147428.9. Examples of logs
14743---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014744
14745These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14746them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14747reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14748
14749 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14750 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14751 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14752
14753 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14754 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14755
14756 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14757 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14758 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14759
14760 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14761 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14762
14763 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14764 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14765 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14766
14767 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014768 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014769 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14770 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14771
14772 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14773 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14774 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14775
14776 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14777 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014778 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014779 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14780 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14781 to return the 502 and not the server.
14782
14783 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014784 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014785
14786 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14787 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14788 Nothing was sent to any server.
14789
14790 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14791 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14792
14793 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14794 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14795 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14796 send a 408 return code to the client.
14797
14798 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14799 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14800
14801 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14802 5 seconds ("c----").
14803
14804 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14805 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014806 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014807
14808 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014810 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14811 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14812 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14813 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14814 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014815
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148179. Statistics and monitoring
14818----------------------------
14819
14820It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14821mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14822CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14823Unix socket.
14824
14825
148269.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014827---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014828
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014829The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014830page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14831begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14832represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14833use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14834('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14835(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14836text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14837do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14838use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014839
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014840In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14841that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14842S (Servers).
14843
14844 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14845 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14846 any name for server/listener)
14847 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14848 number queued without a server assigned.
14849 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14850 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14851 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14852 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14853 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14854 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14855 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14856 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14857 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14858 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14859 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14860 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14861 "option checkcache".
14862 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14863 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14864 - read error from the client
14865 - client timeout
14866 - client closed connection
14867 - various bad requests from the client.
14868 - request was tarpitted.
14869 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14870 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14871 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14872 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14873 active servers).
14874 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14875 Some other errors are:
14876 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14877 - failure applying filters to the response.
14878 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14879 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14880 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14881 switched away from.
14882 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014883 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14884 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14885 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014886 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14887 the server is up.)
14888 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14889 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14890 counters for each server.
14891 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14892 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14893 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14894 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14895 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14896 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14897 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14898 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14899 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14900 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14901 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14902 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14903 of times that server was selected.
14904 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14905 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14906 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14907 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14908 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14909 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014910 UNK -> unknown
14911 INI -> initializing
14912 SOCKERR -> socket error
14913 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014914 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014915 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14916 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14917 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14918 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14919 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14920 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14921 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14922 disable-on-404
14923 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14924 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14925 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014926 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14927 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14928 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14929 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14930 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14931 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14932 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14933 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14934 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14935 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14936 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14937 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14938 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14939 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14940 (inc. in eresp)
14941 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14942 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14943 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14944 (CPU/BW limit)
14945 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14946 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14947 server/backend
14948 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14949 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14950 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14951 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14952 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14953 (0 for TCP)
14954 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14955 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014956
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149589.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014959-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014960
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014961The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14962necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14963A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14964issuing commands by hand :
14965
14966 global
14967 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14968 stats timeout 2m
14969
14970It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14971the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14972never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14973situations :
14974
14975 global
14976 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14977 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14978 stats timeout 2m
14979
14980To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14981swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14982to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14983syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14984
14985 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14986 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14987
14988The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14989script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14990for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14991
14992The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14993that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14994editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14995(eg: watch a counter).
14996
14997The socket supports two operation modes :
14998 - interactive
14999 - non-interactive
15000
15001The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
15002this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
15003sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
15004mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
15005commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
15006example :
15007
15008 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
15009
15010The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
15011entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
15012for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
15013sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
15014"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
15015after processing the last command of the same line.
15016
15017For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
15018"prompt" command :
15019
15020 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
15021 prompt
15022 > show info
15023 ...
15024 >
15025
15026Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
15027delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
15028that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
15029parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015030
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015031It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
15032on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
15033own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015034
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015035The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
15036If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
15037all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
15038it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
15039
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015040add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015041 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
15042 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
15043 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
15044 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015045
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015046add map <map> <key> <value>
15047 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
15048 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015049 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
15050 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
15051 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015053clear counters
15054 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
15055 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
15056 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
15057 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
15058 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15059
15060clear counters all
15061 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
15062 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
15063 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
15064
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015065clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015066 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
15067 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
15068 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015069
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015070clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015071 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
15072 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
15073 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015074
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015075clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
15076 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
15077
15078 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
15079 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
15080 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
15081 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
15082 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
15083 later after the session ends is usual enough.
15084
15085 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
15086
15087 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
15088 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
15089 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
15090 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
15091 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
15092 the ACLs :
15093
15094 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15095 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15096 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15097 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15098 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15099 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15100
15101 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015102 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
15103 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015104
15105 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015106 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015107 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015108 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15109 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15110 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15111 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015112
15113 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15114
15115 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015116 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015117 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15118 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015119 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15120 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15121 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015122
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015123del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15124 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015125 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15126 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15127 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15128 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015129
15130del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015131 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015132 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15133 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15134 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15135 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015136
15137disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015138 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15139
15140 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15141 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15142 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15143 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15144 re-enabled using enable agent.
15145
15146 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15147 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15148 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15149 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15150 otherwise unchanged.
15151
15152 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15153 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15154 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15155
15156 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15157 level "admin".
15158
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015159disable frontend <frontend>
15160 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15161 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15162 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15163 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15164 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15165 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15166 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15167 on the stats page.
15168
15169 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15170 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15171
15172 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15173 level "admin".
15174
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015175disable health <backend>/<server>
15176 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15177 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15178 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15179 agent check forces it down.
15180
15181 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15182 level "admin".
15183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015184disable server <backend>/<server>
15185 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15186 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15187 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15188 during the maintenance.
15189
15190 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15191 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15192
15193 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015194 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015195
15196 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15197 level "admin".
15198
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015199enable agent <backend>/<server>
15200 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15201
15202 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15203 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15204
15205 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15206 level "admin".
15207
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015208enable frontend <frontend>
15209 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15210 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15211 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15212 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15213 which was disabled.
15214
15215 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15216 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15217
15218 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15219 level "admin".
15220
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015221enable health <backend>/<server>
15222 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15223 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15224
15225 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15226 level "admin".
15227
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015228enable server <backend>/<server>
15229 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15230 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15231
15232 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015233 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015234
15235 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15236 level "admin".
15237
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015238get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015239get acl <acl> <value>
15240 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15241 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15242 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15243 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15244 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015245
15246 The first two words are:
15247
15248 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15249 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15250 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15251
15252 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15253
15254 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15255
15256 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15257
15258 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15259 interpretation of the case.
15260
15261 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15262 useful with regular expressions.
15263
15264 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15265 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15266
15267 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15268 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15269 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15270
15271 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015273get weight <backend>/<server>
15274 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15275 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15276 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15277 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15278 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015279 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015280
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015281help
15282 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15283 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015284
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015285prompt
15286 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15287 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15288 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15289 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15290 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15291 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15292 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15293 command.
15294
15295quit
15296 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015297
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015298set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015299 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15300 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15301 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015302
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015303set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015304 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15305 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15306 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15307 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15308 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015309 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15310 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15311
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015312set maxconn global <maxconn>
15313 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15314 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15315 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15316 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15317 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15318 setting.
15319
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015320set rate-limit connections global <value>
15321 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15322 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15323 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15324 is passed in number of connections per second.
15325
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015326set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15327 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15328 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015329 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15330 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015331
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015332set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15333 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15334 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15335 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15336 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15337
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015338set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15339 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15340 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15341 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15342 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15343 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15344
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015345set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15346 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15347
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015348set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15349 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15350 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15351 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15352
15353set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15354 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15355 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15356 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15357
15358set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15359 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15360 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15361 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15362 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15363 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15364 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15365 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15366 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15367
15368set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15369 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15370 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15371
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015372set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15373 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15374 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15375 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15376 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15377
15378 Example:
15379 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15380 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15381 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15382 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15383
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015384set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15385 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15386 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15387 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15388 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15389 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15390
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015391set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015392 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15393 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15394 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15395 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015396 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15397 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015398
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015399set timeout cli <delay>
15400 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15401 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15402 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15403
15404set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15405 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15406 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015407 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15408 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15409 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15410 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15411 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15412 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15413 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15414 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15415 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15416 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15417 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15418 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15419 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015420
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015421show errors [<iid>]
15422 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15423 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015424 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15425 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15426 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015427
15428 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15429 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15430 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15431 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15432 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15433 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15434 are reported too.
15435
15436 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15437 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15438 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15439 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15440 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15441 code.
15442
15443 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15444 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15445 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15446 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15447 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15448 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15449 line.
15450
15451 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015452 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15453 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015454 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15455 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15456
15457 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15458 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15459 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15460 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15461 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15462 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15463 00204+ minal\r\n
15464 00211 \r\n
15465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015466 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015467 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15468 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15469 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15470 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15471 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15472 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015473
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015474show info
15475 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15476
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015477show map [<map>]
15478 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015479 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15480 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15481 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15482 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15483 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15484 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015485
15486show acl [<acl>]
15487 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015488 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15489 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15490 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15491 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15492 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015493
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015494show pools
15495 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15496 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15497 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15498 the pools.
15499
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015500show sess
15501 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015502 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15503 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15504
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015505show sess <id>
15506 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15507 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15508 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15509 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15510 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015511 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15512 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15513
15514 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15515 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015516
15517show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15518 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15519 possible to dump only selected items :
15520 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15521 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15522 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15523 for example:
15524 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15525 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15526 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15527
15528 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015529 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15530 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015531 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15532 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15533 Nbproc: 1
15534 Process_num: 1
15535 (...)
15536
15537 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15538 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15539 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15540 (...)
15541 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15542
15543 $
15544
15545 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15546 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15547 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15548 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015549 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015550
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015551show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15552 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15553 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15554 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15555 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15556 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15557 cname: number of CNAME responses
15558 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15559 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15560 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15561 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15562 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15563 other: any other DNS errors
15564 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15565 too_big: too big response
15566 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15567
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015568show table
15569 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15570 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15571 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15572 entries currently in use.
15573
15574 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015575 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015576 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15577 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015578
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015579show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015580 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15581 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15582 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015583 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15584
15585 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15586 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15587 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15588 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15589 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15590
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015591 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15592 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15593 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15594 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15595 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15596 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15597
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015598
15599 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015600 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15601 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015602
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015603 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015604 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015605 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015606 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15607 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15608 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15609 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015610
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015611 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015612 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015613 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15614 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015615
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015616 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15617 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015618 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015619 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15620 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015621
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015622 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15623 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015624 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015625 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15626 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15627
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015628 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15629 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15630 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15631 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15632 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15633
15634 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15635 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15636 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015637 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15638 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015639 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15640 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015641
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015642show tls-keys
15643 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15644 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15645 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15646
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015647shutdown frontend <frontend>
15648 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15649 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15650 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15651 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15652 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15653 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15654 once it is terminated.
15655
15656 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15657 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15658
15659 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15660 level "admin".
15661
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015662shutdown session <id>
15663 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15664 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15665 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15666 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15667 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15668 flag in the logs.
15669
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015670shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015671 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15672 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15673 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15674 'K' flag in the logs.
15675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015676/*
15677 * Local variables:
15678 * fill-column: 79
15679 * End:
15680 */